Program
Program
Programming
TRACER SUMMIT™
Version 16
BMTX-SVP01A-EN
System
Programming
Tracer Summit™
Version 16
This guide and the information in it are the property of American Standard Inc. and shall not be used or reproduced in whole or in part,
except as intended, without the written permission of American Standard Inc. Trane, a division of American Standard, Inc., has a
policy of continuous product improvement and reserves the right to change design and specification without notice.
Use of the software contained in this package is provided under a software license agreement. Unauthorized use of the software or
related materials discussed in this manual can result in civil damages and criminal penalties. The terms of this license are included
with the compact disk. Please read them thoroughly.
Although Trane has tested the described in this guide, no guarantee is offered that the system and software are error free.
Trane reserves the right to revise this publication at any time and to make changes to its content without obligation to notify any per-
son of such revision or change.
Trane may have patents or pending patent applications covering items in this publication. By providing this document, Trane does not
imply giving license to these patents.
™® The following are trademarks or registered trademarks of American Standard Inc.: IntelliPak, TCM, Tracer Summit, Trane,
Voyager, Tracer, UCP2, CenTraVac, ICS, VariTrane, Horizon, and Tracker.
™® The following are trademarks or registered trademarks of their respective companies or organizations: Adobe and Acrobat
from Adobe Systems Incorporated; ARCNET from Datapoint Corporation; AutoCAD from Autodesk; BACnet from ASHRAE;
CorelDRAW from Corel Corporation; LonTalk, LonMark, and Neuron from Echelon Corporation; Modbus from Schneider
Electric; Paintshop Pro from Jasc Software, Inc.; Windows, Internet Explorer, and Microsoft are registered trademarks of
Microsoft Corporation in the United States and other countries.
BMTX-SVP01A-EN
NOTICE:
Warnings and Cautions appear at appropriate sections throughout this manual. Read these carefully:
WARNING
Indicates a potentially hazardous situation, which, if not avoided, could result in death or serious injury.
CAUTION
Indicates a potentially hazardous situation, which, if not avoided, may result in minor or moderate injury.
It may also be used to alert against unsafe practices
CAUTION
Indicates a situation that may result in equipment damage or property damage.
The following format and symbol conventions appear at appropriate sections throughout this manual:
IMPORTANT
Alerts installer, servicer, or operator to potential actions that could cause the product or system to
operate improperly but will not likely result in potential for damage.
Note:
A note may be used to make the reader aware of useful information, to clarify a point, or to describe
options or alternatives.
BMTX-SVP01A-EN
Table of Contents
Chapter 1 Introduction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1
Tracer Summit Optional Value-added Packages . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1
Important Things to Know Before Using this Guide . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3
For More Information . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4
Further References . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4
BMTX-SVP01A-EN i
Table of Contents
Chapter 5 Utilities . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 25
Viewing the Tracer Summit Electronic Library . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 25
Viewing an Object’s Properties. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 27
Viewing System Status . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 29
ii BMTX-SVP01A-EN
Table of Contents
BMTX-SVP01A-EN iii
Table of Contents
iv BMTX-SVP01A-EN
Table of Contents
BMTX-SVP01A-EN v
Table of Contents
vi BMTX-SVP01A-EN
Table of Contents
BMTX-SVP01A-EN vii
Table of Contents
viii BMTX-SVP01A-EN
Table of Contents
BMTX-SVP01A-EN ix
Table of Contents
x BMTX-SVP01A-EN
Table of Contents
BMTX-SVP01A-EN xi
Table of Contents
xii BMTX-SVP01A-EN
Table of Contents
BMTX-SVP01A-EN xiii
Table of Contents
xiv BMTX-SVP01A-EN
Table of Contents
BMTX-SVP01A-EN xv
Table of Contents
xvi BMTX-SVP01A-EN
Table of Contents
BMTX-SVP01A-EN xvii
Table of Contents
Glossary . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 619
Index . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 637
Reader Response Form . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 651
xviii BMTX-SVP01A-EN
Chapter 1
Introduction
Tracer
100/ Building Enterprise
Feature/Description Tracer Tracker Manage- Manage-
Summit Commun- ment ment
ication
BMTX-SVP01A-EN 1
Introduction
Tracer
Tracer 100/ Building Enterprise
Feature/Description Summit Tracker Manage- Manage-
Commun- ment ment
ication
Global changes
Using global changes, modify items in one site and easily have
X
those changes take effect at other sites within a group.
Select several similar objects in a site, modify them, and have
X X X X
those changes take effect for all the selected objects.
Groups
Define individual sites as parts of a group. Assign levels of user
X
access to the groups.
Message forwarding
Forward alarms to a user-defined e-mail address. Users
defined as on-call recipients can receive the e-mails on PCs or X X X X
at their pagers.
Multi-user database sharing
Handle large numbers of sites and share the database from a
central server.
X
* Tracer Summit has been designed to work specifically with
Microsoft SQL Server databases.
Navigation tree
Now has Windows Explorer features such as drag and drop,
X X X X
open, cut and paste, and find.
Task manager
• Schedule automatic scans and backups of sites
• Start immediate scan of single remote sites
• Download off-line global changes made to sites X X
• Automatically archive the event log as a Microsoft Excel file,
as a text file, or as both
Tracer 100 and Tracker (EMTK) Support and Tracer 100 or Tracker Configuration
• Connect to Tracer 100 and Tracker (EMTK) panels
• Communicate with Tracer 100 and Tracker panels using
BMN-like terminal emulation
• Edit calculated binary/analog, and schedules. Run equip- X X
ment diagnostic summary reports
• Download schedules to Tracer 100 panels
• Override calculated binary/analog (point types 8 and 11)
2 BMTX-SVP01A-EN
Important Things to Know Before Using this Guide
BMTX-SVP01A-EN 3
Introduction
Further References
Tracer 100 Series Panels
• Tracer 100 Series Installation Guide (EMTF-IN-6)
• Tracer 100 Series Operator’s Guide (EMTB-OG-15)
• Tracer 100 Series Programming Guide (EMTB-PG-11)
• Tracer 100 Version 15.1 Addendum to Tracer 100 Series Literature
(EMTB-AD-4)
• T100 Version Conversion Programs (EMTB-IN-10)
• Tracer 100 Troubleshooting/Repair (EMTB-TSR-2A)
• Tracer 100i, 100L, and Chiller Plant Manager Troubleshooting/
Repair (EMTF-TSR-1)
• Tracer 100 Installation Guide (EMTB-IN-12)
• Tracer 100 Series Building Management System Unit-To-Unit Com-
munications (BAS-EB-12)
• Tracer 100 Series Software Versions (BAS-EB-25)
• Tracer 100 Series Custom Reports (BAS-EB-54)
• Tracer 100i, 100L, and Chiller Plant Manager Installation Guide
(EMTF-IN-6)
4 BMTX-SVP01A-EN
For More Information
Tracker Panels
• Tracker Installation Guide (EMTK-IN-7)
• Tracker Operator’s Guide (EMTK-OG-8)
Tracer Summit
• Tracer Summit for Windows and Ethernet (BAS-EB-70)
• Commissioning Tracer Summit BACnet Projects (BAS-PRB002-EN)
• Tracer Summit Connections to LonTalk Devices (BAS-PRB003-EN)
• Tracer Summit BACnet/IP Network Installations (BAS-PRB004-EN)
• Building Control Unit Sizing for Tracer Summit Systems (BAS-
PRB005-EN)
• Tracer Summit Chiller Plant Control (BAS-EB-64)
• Tracer Summit Software Versions (BAS-PRB-006-EN)
• Tracer Summit Multisite Best Practices (BAS-PRB011-EN)
BMTX-SVP01A-EN 5
Introduction
6 BMTX-SVP01A-EN
Chapter 2
Setting Up a PC Workstation
(Refer to Tracer Summit Hardware and Software Installation guide.)
1. Install one of the following operating systems: Windows NT 4.0 (SP6
or greater), Windows XP (SP1 or greater) or Windows 2000 (SP3 or
greater).
2. Install Tracer Summit using the CD.
3. Install the ARCNET or Ethernet related hardware and software.
4. Install a Trane-specified modem in the PC workstation if the PC
workstation communicates remotely with a BCU.
5. Install any additional customer software.
6. Have the building owner set up TCP/IP support, if required.
Setting Up a Site
1. Use the Site Creation/Connection Wizard to create, upload, or connect
to a site. (See Chapter 6, “Configuring Tracer Summit BCU Sites” and
Chapter 7, “Defining Tracer 100 or Tracker Sites.”)
2. Define units of measure. (See Chapter 6, “Configuring Tracer Summit
BCU Sites.”)
3. Define devices (PC workstations, BCUs and non-Trane devices). (See
Chapter 6, “Configuring Tracer Summit BCU Sites” and Chapter 7,
“Defining Tracer 100 or Tracker Sites.”)
Note:
Back up the Tracer Summit system periodically during this
process.
BMTX-SVP01A-EN 7
Programming Order Checklist
8 BMTX-SVP01A-EN
Setting Up Graphics
Setting Up Graphics
1. Create graphics. (See Chapter 27, “Using the Graphics Editor.”)
2. Set up the navigation tree. (See Chapter 25, “Using the Navigation
Tree.”)
Setting Up Reports
1. Set up trends. (See Chapter 28, “Using the Trend Editor.”)
2. Set up calculations. (See Chapter 29, “Using the Calculations Editor.”)
3. Design reports. (See Chapter 30, “Designing Reports.”)
BMTX-SVP01A-EN 9
Programming Order Checklist
10 BMTX-SVP01A-EN
Chapter 3
IMPORTANT
For the most efficient and trouble-free programming, use online pro-
gramming whenever possible.
BMTX-SVP01A-EN 11
Online and Offline Programming
Online Programming
Online programming is recommended for several reasons:
• With online programming, the order in which programming occurs
determines the settings in the system. For example, if one PC Work-
station programs a setpoint at 1:00 P.M., then another PC Worksta-
tion programs the same setpoint at 2:00 P.M., the programming that
occurred at 2:00 P.M. automatically takes precedence and replaces
the earlier programming in the first PC.
• Some configuration information and internal diagnostics reside in the
BCUs. When the PC Workstation is online, all the information in the
BCUs is available.
• Some configuration information and internal diagnostics reside in the
unit controllers. When the PC is online, and the unit controllers are
connected and communicating to the BCU(s), all the information is
available.
• With online programming, you can immediately verify each step in
the process.
IMPORTANT
Offline programming changes must be performed on a single PC Work-
station. Choose a single workstation to serve as the master worksta-
tion and perform all offline programming on that workstation only. A
master workstation prevents the loss of user program data. This may
occur when changes that have been made by one user are overwritten
by changes made by another user. The workstation keeps a copy of the
programming in its database on its hard drive. When the BCUs are
installed and online, the PC Workstation downloads this database to
the BCUs.
12 BMTX-SVP01A-EN
Offline Programming on a New Site
You should test any setup functions performed with offline program-
ming after the BCUs and PC Workstations are online and the database
has been downloaded.
BMTX-SVP01A-EN 13
Online and Offline Programming
Note:
If you have the Enterprise Management package, you can make
programming changes to groups of sites. Offline programming
is recommended to take full advantage of the application. For
more information, see “Programming Offline with Global
Changes” on page 18.
When you must modify an existing site offline, be sure that the following
conditions exist:
• Make sure the latest copy of the database is loaded onto the offline
computer. If the workstation or laptop has been online with the
Tracer Summit system, it will contain the latest database. If the com-
puter hasn’t been online, you can copy the database to it using Tracer
Summit’s Backup Site Database utility.
• If possible, prevent other PC Workstations from making edit changes
to the system while the offline programming is in process. When
offline programming is downloaded to the BCUs, it will overwrite any
changes made from another workstation.
For example, if the same alarm limit in an analog input is pro-
grammed to 50°F by an operator online and then to 45°F by an opera-
tor offline, the newly downloaded offline setting (45°F) will take
precedence and overwrite the online setting when the offline program
is downloaded.
To program an existing site offline, follow the steps in the section “Pro-
gramming an Existing Site Offline” on page 14.
After you have programmed the site, you need to either update or replace
the existing site. Refer to “Updating an Existing Site with Offline Pro-
gramming Changes” on page 15 or “Replacing an Existing Site with a Site
Programmed Offline” on page 16.
14 BMTX-SVP01A-EN
Offline Programming of an Existing Site
BMTX-SVP01A-EN 15
Online and Offline Programming
16 BMTX-SVP01A-EN
Offline and Online Programming of Tracer 100 Sites
BMTX-SVP01A-EN 17
Online and Offline Programming
18 BMTX-SVP01A-EN
Chapter 4
Mode button
Note:
For more information on objects and properties, refer to Chap-
ter 5, “Utilities”.
BMTX-SVP01A-EN 19
Using Referencer Edit Controls
Constant Mode
This mode allows you to either:
• Input a constant numerical value to control the field for analog fields.
(The decimal place does not display if an integer is expected.)
• Select a constant value from a pull-down list (On/Off, Enable/Disable)
if it is a binary or a multi-state field (see Figure 2).
20 BMTX-SVP01A-EN
Referencer Edit Control Modes
Referencer Mode
This mode allows you to reference another system property to control the
field. Until you have selected a valid property in the referencer mode, the
referencer edit control field is left blank. Once you have chosen a valid
property, the property’s value displays in the referencer edit control field.
You can get to the referencer mode by clicking the mode button until the
referencer button (...) is available on the right side of the field (see
Figure 3).
Note:
Tracer Summit retains the selected property reference informa-
tion even when the mode is changed to a constant or to the Not
Used mode, but the value of the property will come from the
most recently selected mode. This affects your ability to delete
the object that contains the referenced property.
To reference a property:
1. Click the mode button in the referencer edit control field to toggle
through the referencer edit modes until the referencer mode displays
(see Figure 4).
2. Click the referencer button. The Select Property Reference dialog box
displays (see Figure 5).
BMTX-SVP01A-EN 21
Using Referencer Edit Controls
3. Select the object type you would like to reference from the Type drop-
down list.
4. Select the object you would like to reference from the Name drop-
down list. The list contains only objects of the type you have chosen.
5. Select the property that will control the field from the Property list
box. Only those properties belonging to the particular object you
chose are available in this box. Depending on the type of field you are
working with, the system automatically filters property types that
are not appropriate. For example, if you are in a field that requires an
analog entry, the dialog box displays with only analog properties to
choose from.
6. Click OK when you have made your selections. To exit without saving,
click Cancel.
Until you select a property reference, the referencer mode in the ref-
erencer edit control field is left blank. After you choose a valid prop-
erty, the property’s value displays in the referencer edit control field.
If “???” displays in the referencer edit control field, the referencer has
failed and the system cannot access the referenced property.
Referencers fail when Tracer Summit cannot get the referenced value
back from the object where the property resides. This occurs when the
communications between the PC workstation and BCU are down, or
when you reference a property that is offline.
22 BMTX-SVP01A-EN
Referencer Edit Control Modes
For example, if Not Used is selected for the occupied cooling setpoint in a
VAV UCM, the system calculates the setpoint by adding the differential
to the occupied heating setpoint.
BMTX-SVP01A-EN 23
Using Referencer Edit Controls
24 BMTX-SVP01A-EN
Chapter 5
Utilities
BMTX-SVP01A-EN 25
Utilities
26 BMTX-SVP01A-EN
Viewing an Object’s Properties
BMTX-SVP01A-EN 27
Utilities
Note:
If you have selected and added several properties and then you
select a different object name (keeping the object type the
same), those same properties are selected for the new object
name. You can simply click the Add button to add them to the
Selected Properties list. This can also be done for different
object types and site names, allowing a broad variety of infor-
mation to be displayed at one time.
10. To print the display, from the File menu, select Print. At the Print
dialog box, click OK.
Note:
The objects and properties cannot be edited or saved from the
display. To edit objects or properties, you must display the
appropriate editor from the Tracer Summit Setup menu.
11. When you are finished viewing the properties, from the File menu,
select Close Graphic.
28 BMTX-SVP01A-EN
Viewing System Status
Tracer Summit
System Status Icon
BMTX-SVP01A-EN 29
Utilities
Note:
The only sites that appear in the system status window are
those sites that the workstation is communicating with or is
attempting to communicate with.
IMPORTANT
Disconnecting without synchronizing the PC workstation and BCU
databases may cause an incomplete database, resulting in improper
system control.
30 BMTX-SVP01A-EN
Viewing System Status
Connection
Status Description
BMTX-SVP01A-EN 31
Utilities
32 BMTX-SVP01A-EN
Chapter 6
BMTX-SVP01A-EN 33
Configuring Tracer Summit BCU Sites
Creating a Site
Tracer Summit’s Site Creation/Connection Wizard allows you to create
and configure a site entirely from your PC workstation. You can also
upload. restore, or copy an existing site with a LAN (BACnet/IP, Ether-
net, or ARCNET), modem, or direct connection.
As a part of the site creation process, the Site Creation Wizard automati-
cally takes you to the Site Configuration editor, where you finish configur-
ing your site.
This section covers:
• Creating a site
• Uploading a site
• Restoring a site
• Copying a site
34 BMTX-SVP01A-EN
Creating a Site
2. Click New. The Site Creation Wizard dialog box displays (see
Figure 14).
3. Click Create.
4. Enter a name in the Site Name field. Make the name as informative
as possible. Use a maximum of eight characters.
Note:
After you save this site configuration, the site name cannot be
modified in the Site Configuration editor. Use the backup and
restore functions, to restore the site under a new name (see
Chapter 36, “Restoring into the Tracer Summit Workstation”).
5. Click Next to display the Site Connection Wizard dialog box (see
Figure 15).
BMTX-SVP01A-EN 35
Configuring Tracer Summit BCU Sites
6. Click the type of connection for your site. Only one network connec-
tion type can be defined.
7. Click Next. Depending on the type of connection you selected, a con-
figuration dialog box specific to that connection is displayed.
Note:
Tracer Summit menus are unavailable until you save the site
or cancel the site.
36 BMTX-SVP01A-EN
Creating a Site
3. Click:
• Use Local Connection if your workstation is on an IP subnet that
has a BCU.
• Use BBMD if your workstation is on a subnet that does not have a
BCU.
Note:
This dialog box helps Tracer Summit determine how to connect
to the site. It allows you to connect to a BCU on a local subnet,
or connect to a remote part of the facility, or connect to another
building. The building owner’s information systems (IS) staff
can tell you if the PC workstation and the BCU are on the same
subnet.
BACnet broadcast management devices (BBMDs) are used to
facilitate low level communications. On most sites the BCU
serves as a BBMD. However, it is possible for other BACnet
devices, such as, a BACnet IP router to fill this function.
4. Click Next:
• If you selected the Use Local Connection option, the Network
Adapter Selection dialog box displays (see Figure 18 on page 38
below).
• If you selected the Use BBMD option, the BBMD Configuration
dialog box displays (see Figure 19 on page 39).
BMTX-SVP01A-EN 37
Configuring Tracer Summit BCU Sites
1. Select the network adapter. Note that the IP address shown is the
address of this Workstation adapter.
2. Type the UDP port number in the Port field. This will typically be
47808.
3. The Open On Startup check box is checked by default. Leave this box
checked if you want the workstation to communicate to the site via
BACnet/IP each time you start Tracer Summit.
4. Click Finish. The Site Configuration editor is displayed.
When you create a new site you must designate units of measure for
the site, and assign at least one BCU before you can save the new site
(see“Creating, Editing, and Deleting Devices” on page 57 and “Creat-
ing, Editing, and Deleting PC Workstations” on page 66).
Note:
Tracer Summit menus are unavailable until you save the site
or cancel the site.
38 BMTX-SVP01A-EN
Creating a Site
1. Type the IP address of the BCU (or other BACnet device acting as a
BBMD) in the BBMD Address field.
2. Type the UDP port number in the Port field. The other address is pro-
vided by the building owner’s IS staff.
3. The Open On Startup check box is checked by default. Leave this box
checked if you want the workstation to communicate to the site via
BACnet/IP each time you start Tracer Summit.
4. Click Finish the Site Configuration editor is displayed.
When you create a new site you must designate units of measure for
the site, and assign at least one BCU before you can save the new site
(see “Creating, Editing, and Deleting Devices” on page 57 and “Creat-
ing, Editing, and Deleting PC Workstations” on page 66).
Note:
Tracer Summit menus are unavailable until you save the site
or cancel the site.
BMTX-SVP01A-EN 39
Configuring Tracer Summit BCU Sites
40 BMTX-SVP01A-EN
Creating a Site
2. Click New. The Site Creation Wizard dialog box displays (see
Figure 22).
3. Click Upload.
4. Click Next to display the Site Connection Wizard dialog box (see
Figure 23).
BMTX-SVP01A-EN 41
Configuring Tracer Summit BCU Sites
42 BMTX-SVP01A-EN
Creating a Site
The Upload Status dialog box displays with the current status of the con-
nection and the upload (see Figure 27).
When the upload is complete, you are returned to the Tracer Summit
main window. The new site is now the active site.
BMTX-SVP01A-EN 43
Configuring Tracer Summit BCU Sites
2. Click New. The Site Creation Wizard dialog box displays (see
Figure 29).
3. Click Upload.
4. Click Next to display the Site Connection Wizard dialog box (see
Figure 30 on page 45).
44 BMTX-SVP01A-EN
Creating a Site
5. Click BACnet/IP.
6. Click Next to display the BACnet/IP Configuration dialog box (see
Figure 31).
7. Click:
• Use Local Connection if your workstation is on an IP subnet that
has a BCU.
• Click Use BBMD if your workstation is on a subnet that does not
have a BCU.
BMTX-SVP01A-EN 45
Configuring Tracer Summit BCU Sites
Note:
This dialog box helps Tracer Summit determine how to connect
to the site. It allows you to connect to a BCU on a local subnet,
or connect to a remote part of the facility, or connect to another
building. The building owner’s information systems (IS) staff
can tell you if the PC workstation and the BCU are on the same
subnet.
BACnet broadcast management devices (BBMDs) are used to
facilitate low level communications. On most sites the BCU
serves as a BBMD. However, it is possible for other BACnet
devices, such as, a BACnet IP router to fill this function.
8. Click Next:
• If you selected the Use Local Connection option, the Network
Adapter box displays (see Figure 32).
• If you selected the Use BBMD option, the BBMD Configuration
dialog box displays (see Figure 35 on page 48).
46 BMTX-SVP01A-EN
Creating a Site
3. The Open on Startup check box is checked by default. Leave this box
checked if you want the workstation to communicate to the site via
BACnet/IP each time you start Tracer Summit.
4. Click Finish.
Note:
The system checks to see if your user name (the one you used to
log onto the current site) is defined on the site you are trying to
upload.
5. The Confirm Upload Site dialog box displays (see Figure 33). Click
Yes to continue the upload.
The Upload Status dialog box displays with the current status of the con-
nection and the upload (see Figure 34).
When the upload is complete, you are returned to the Tracer Summit
main window. The new site is now the active site.
BMTX-SVP01A-EN 47
Configuring Tracer Summit BCU Sites
1. Type the IP address of the BCU (or other BACnet device acting as a
BBMD) in the BBMD Address field.
2. Type the UDP port number in the Port field. The other address is pro-
vided by the building owner’s IS staff.
3. The Open on Startup check box is checked by default. Leave this box
checked if you want the workstation to communicate to the site via
BACnet/IP each time you start Tracer Summit.
4. Click Finish. Tracer Summit begins to upload the site (refer to steps
four and five of the IP Address Configuration Dialog Box section).
48 BMTX-SVP01A-EN
Creating a Site
2. Click New. The Site Creation Wizard dialog box displays (see
Figure 37).
3. Click Upload.
4. Click Next to display the Site Connection Wizard dialog box (see
Figure 38 on page 50).
BMTX-SVP01A-EN 49
Configuring Tracer Summit BCU Sites
50 BMTX-SVP01A-EN
Creating a Site
Note:
If there is a modem that is being used for another site, click
Current Connections. At the Current Connections dialog box,
select the site currently using the modem/port and click Discon-
nect. When the site has disconnected, click OK to return to the
Connection Manager.
10. In the Phone Number field, select the telephone number for the
remote connection.
11. If there is no phone number, add one in the Phone Book. Click the
Phone Book button to display the Phone Book dialog box (see
Figure 41 on page 52).
BMTX-SVP01A-EN 51
Configuring Tracer Summit BCU Sites
12. Click the Add Phone Number button to display the Add Phone Num-
bers dialog box (see Figure 42).
13. Enter a phone number in the Phone Number field and select the Use
Dialing Prefix or Use Calling Card # check box as necessary.
14. Click OK to close the Add Phone Numbers dialog box, then click OK
to return to the Connection Manager dialog box.
15. In the Connection Manager dialog box, click OK. The system dials
and connects to the site.
Note:
The system checks to see if your user name (the one you used to
log onto the current site) is defined on the site you are trying to
be upload.
16. The Confirm Upload Site dialog box displays (see Figure 43 on
page 53).
17. Click Yes to continue the upload.
52 BMTX-SVP01A-EN
Creating a Site
The Upload Status dialog box displays with the current status of the con-
nection and the upload (see Figure 44).
When the upload is complete, you are returned to the Tracer Summit
main window. The new site is now the active site.
BMTX-SVP01A-EN 53
Configuring Tracer Summit BCU Sites
Copying a Site
Copy Site helps you create sites that are similar or identical to each other.
If you have a large number of sites, Copy Site can eliminate much of the
repetitive work that goes into configuring sites that have more similari-
ties than differences.
Copy Site is available with all Version 13 packages (Tracer 100/Tracker
Communication, Building Management, and Enterprise Management).
Copy Site reproduces objects from an original BCU site and transfers
them to a new site of the same type. Copy Site functions like the Restore
function (see “Restoring a Site and CPL Files” on page 591), except that
with Copy Site you can copy BCU graphic objects and report objects to a
new site.
Copy Site does not copy workstation or global objects from the original
site. This means that the new site will have the same information as the
original from which it was copied but not the following items:
• Workstation modem objects
• Message forwarding objects
• Global graphics
• Sample values in calculation objects (samples are cleared in the new
objects)
• Sample values in trend objects (samples are cleared in the new
objects)
• CPL text files
• Report text files (*.rpt files)
• User-defined standard live reports
54 BMTX-SVP01A-EN
Selecting a Site to Configure
Tracer Summit copies the information that you selected from the orig-
inal site. The new BCU site node appears in the navigation tree.
BMTX-SVP01A-EN 55
Configuring Tracer Summit BCU Sites
Configuring a Site
To configure a new site on your PC workstation or to modify parameters
of an existing site, follow the steps in this section.
Note:
When you create a new site, the Site Configuration editor opens
with the Units screen active. You can select units of measure
only when you are creating a new site. Once the site is saved,
the Units screen becomes status only.
2. In the Setup Options field, select the units of measure for the site.
3. If you select Customize from I-P or Customize from SI, click the first
item in the Physical Quantity list that you wish to customize. A choice
of units for that item is displayed in the Units list.
4. Click the desired unit in the Units field.
5. Repeat steps 3 and 4 for each item in the Physical Quantity field you
wish to customize.
6. Follow the instruction in the section “Creating, Editing, and Deleting
Devices” to add a BCU and a PC workstation to the new site before
you can save it.
56 BMTX-SVP01A-EN
Creating, Editing, and Deleting Devices
Creating a Device
1. Click the Devices tab from the Site Configuration editor to display the
Devices screen (see Figure 49).
2. Click the Create Device button to display the Create New Device dia-
log box (see Figure 50 on page 58).
BMTX-SVP01A-EN 57
Configuring Tracer Summit BCU Sites
3. Type a name in the Device Name field. Make the name as informative
as possible. Use a maximum of 32 characters.
4. Select a device number in the Device ID field.
▲IMPORTANT
Once you save the site configuration the Device ID field is fixed and you
cannot change it. Additionally, once you save the site configuration you
can not delete the Device in site configuration. Use the Delete Object
function from the Tools menu.
Note:
Tracer Summit provides a default device ID. The first BCU cre-
ated is ID 1. Each additional BCU is given the next available
ID. To change the suggested ID, type a new ID number in the
field.
Note:
The network number for the device is edited only when there
are multiple networks on a site, typically on a BACnet job with
non-Trane equipment. Contact Trane GCC Product Support for
details.
58 BMTX-SVP01A-EN
Creating, Editing, and Deleting Devices
6. From the Panel Type list box, select a device type: Enhanced BCU
(BMTX), Modular BCU (BMTW) or BCU (BMTS).
• For the BMTW, select capacity cards; 1 for standard and 2 for
high.
• For the BMTX the communication links are fixed, for example,
the comm5 link can only be set up as comm5 or Undefined (not
used), it can not be changed to comm4 or comm3 (see Figure 51).
7. For the standard capacity BMTW, if you select Comm5 as a communi-
cation link, two Comm5 mode options become available: Install a new
link and Add to or discover existing link.
• Select Install new link to enable the auto-install mode to commis-
sion Comm5 devices. In this mode, the BCU discovers Comm5
devices. Select this option if you know that a service tool (Rover,
for example) has not been used to bind devices (custom bindings)
together. This option is faster than the Add to or discover existing
link option.
• Select Add to or discover existing link for existing Comm5 or Lon-
Talk networks. Initial installation takes longer with this option.
However, all existing (custom) bindings and link information are
preserved.
IMPORTANT
Selecting the Install new link option for a network that has existing
device bindings will result in removing those device bindings.
BMTX-SVP01A-EN 59
Configuring Tracer Summit BCU Sites
2. Type a name in the Modem Name field. Make the name as informa-
tive as possible. Use a maximum of 32 characters.
3. To change the default security access for the modem, click Security
Classes (see “Setting Security Access for Objects in a Site” on
page 90).
4. Click OK to close the Modem dialog box.
Note:
To view alarms and events at the operator display, you must
save the BCU event log object to the same device as the opera-
tor display object.
60 BMTX-SVP01A-EN
Creating, Editing, and Deleting Devices
2. Type a name in the event log name field. Make the name as informa-
tive as possible. Use a maximum of 32 characters.
3. To change the default security access for the BCU Event Log, click
Security Classes (see “Setting Security Access for Objects in a Site” on
page 90).
4. Click OK to close the BCU Event Log dialog box and to return to the
Create Devices dialog box .
Note:
The BCU Event Log object is not created until you click Save on
the Devices screen.
5. From the Events Routing tab, set up event receiver routing for the
newly created event log object. Alarms in the event log object show up
in the newly created operator display (see “Setting Up Event Routing”
on page 82).
Editing a BCU
1. Click the Devices tab from the Site Configuration editor to display the
Devices screen (see Figure 54 on page 62).
BMTX-SVP01A-EN 61
Configuring Tracer Summit BCU Sites
2. Click the name of the device you wish to edit in the Devices list.
3. Click Edit Device to display the Edit Device dialog box (see Figure 55
on page 63).
62 BMTX-SVP01A-EN
Creating, Editing, and Deleting Devices
Note:
Once you add a UCM on a selected communication link on the
BMTW, the link designation cannot be changed: You cannot
modify the link when it is in use. To change the link type, you
must first delete all UCMs on the link. On the BMTX BCU each
of the links is predefined and can’t be changed except to set it
“Undefined” (not used).
Note:
Select this option to preserve any custom bindings.
BMTX-SVP01A-EN 63
Configuring Tracer Summit BCU Sites
• Select Install a new link to have the BCU discover all Comm5 devices
on the link but to ignore their custom bindings the next time RAM is
cleared in the BCU.
Note:
• Select this option if you know that there are no custom
bindings on the link, or if you wish to remove all of the cus-
tom bindings on the link.
IMPORTANT
Selecting the Install new link option for a network that has existing
device bindings (custom bindings) will result in removing those device
bindings.
6. In the Modem group, click the Add button to display the Create New
Modem dialog box (see Figure 56).
7. If a modem was previously added to the device, the Add button
becomes unavailable, and the Edit button is now available. Click the
Edit button to display the Edit Modem dialog box. (See Figure 56.)
Figure 56. Create New Modem and Edit Modem Dialog Boxes
8. To modify the modem name, type a new name in the Modem Name
field.
9. Click OK to display the Edit Device dialog box.
10. To delete the modem, click Delete.
11. Add or Edit the BCU I/O Module, the Operator Display or the BCU
Event Log by the same procedure described above for the Modem.
12. To modify the security classes for the Device, click Security Classes
(see “Changing Security Access for Objects in a Site” on page 17).
13. Click OK to close the Edit Device dialog box and display the Devices
screen.
64 BMTX-SVP01A-EN
Creating, Editing, and Deleting Devices
Deleting a Device
Note:
If the device has been saved in site configuration, you cannot
delete the device from the Site Configuration editor (the Delete
Device button is unavailable). Instead, use the Delete Object
utility from the Tools menu to delete a Device (see Chapter 37,
“Deleting Objects and Sites”).
2. Click the name of the device in the Devices list that you wish to
delete.
3. If the Device has not yet been saved and no UCMs have been created,
the Delete button will be highlighted, Click Delete Device.
Note:
Once the device has been saved it can only be deleted using the
Delete Object function from the Tools menu.
BMTX-SVP01A-EN 65
Configuring Tracer Summit BCU Sites
Creating a PC Workstation
1. Click the Devices tab from the Site Configuration editor to display the
Devices screen (see Figure 58).
66 BMTX-SVP01A-EN
Creating, Editing, and Deleting Devices
Note:
Tracer Summit provides a default Workstation Device ID based
on the number assigned during the software installation. Gen-
erally, the first workstation created is ID 80. Each additional
workstation number is increased in increments of one. To
change the default ID, enter a new ID number in the field.
Typical workstation addressing is as follows:
• 80 – 100 for on-site workstations
• 101 – 120 for remote workstations
• 121 – 140 Trane-reserved addressing
Editing a PC Workstation
1. Click the Devices tab from the Site Configuration editor to display the
Devices screen (see Figure 60).
BMTX-SVP01A-EN 67
Configuring Tracer Summit BCU Sites
2. Click the name of the workstation you wish to edit in the Worksta-
tions list.
3. Click Edit Workstation to display the Edit Workstation dialog box
(see Figure 61).
Deleting a PC Workstation
Note:
If the workstation has been saved in site configuration, you
cannot delete the workstation from the Site Configuration edi-
tor (the Delete Workstation button is unavailable). Instead, use
the Delete Object utility from the Tools menu to delete a Device
(see Chapter 37, “Deleting Objects and Sites”).
68 BMTX-SVP01A-EN
Creating, Editing, and Deleting Devices
2. Click the name of the workstation in the Workstations list that you
want to delete.
3. Click the Delete Workstation button.
BMTX-SVP01A-EN 69
Configuring Tracer Summit BCU Sites
70 BMTX-SVP01A-EN
Creating, Editing, and Deleting Devices
3. Type the name and the device ID for the BACnet device..
Note:
The device ID is provided by the device manufacturer. Each
device on a network must have a unique device ID. Contact the
manufacturer for instructions, if necessary.
4. Select the object type from the Object Types field. The default selec-
tion is All Types.
5. Click the Scan button to display a list of all the available objects in
the non-Trane device.
6. From the Available Objects list, select the objects that you want to
view. Then, click the Add button to add the items to the Selected
Objects list.
7. Click Okay to save the changes and return to the Devices tab.
8. Click the Communications tab and check the Disable Automatic
Updates box (see Figure 65).
2. Click the name of the non-Trane BACnet device you wish to edit in
the Non-Trane BACnet Devices box.
3. Click Edit Non-Trane BACnet Device to display the Edit Non-Trane
BACnet Device dialog box (see Figure 67 on page 72).
BMTX-SVP01A-EN 71
Configuring Tracer Summit BCU Sites
4. Modify the the name and object type. Or, manually add new objects, if
desired.
5. Click OK to close the Edit Non-Trane BACnet Device dialog box and
display the Devices screen.
Note:
If the non-Trane BACnet device has been saved in site configu-
ration, you cannot delete the device from the Site Configuration
editor (the Delete Non-Trane BACnet Device button is unavail-
able). Instead, use the Delete Object utility from the Tools
menu to delete the device (see Chapter 37, “Deleting Objects
and Sites”).
72 BMTX-SVP01A-EN
Creating, Editing, and Deleting Devices
BMTX-SVP01A-EN 73
Configuring Tracer Summit BCU Sites
Note:
The UCMs in Selected Device list can be sorted alphabetically
by each column. To sort the list, click the column header.
Creating UCMs
1. Click the Devices tab from the Site Configuration editor to display the
Devices screen (see Figure 69).
2. Click the name of the device in the Devices list to which you wish to
assign UCMs.
3. Click Create UCM to display the Create UCMs dialog box for the
selected device (see Figure 70 on page 75).
Note:
Tracer Summit communication links and devices have a limit
to the number of UCMs they can support. Tracer Summit
checks the number of UCMs per link and per device and allows
you to enter only the appropriate number of UCMs.
74 BMTX-SVP01A-EN
Creating, Editing, and Deleting Devices
4. In the BCU Link field, click the type of communication link the UCMs
will use.
Note:
The BCU Link field displays the names of the links you defined
in the BCU setup. To add a new communication link, see “Edit-
ing a BCU” on page 61.
5. Click the arrow to the right of the UCM Type field to select from a list
of available UCM types for the particular communication link
selected in the BCU Link field.
6. Type a name in the UCM Address Name field.
Note:
If you are creating multiple UCMs, Tracer Summit will use the
name you enter as the base name followed by numbers for the
communication link and the address. For example if you enter
Rooftop Unit as the name for three UCMs on Link 1, the system
would name the units Rooftop Unit-01-033, Rooftop Unit-01-
034, and Rooftop Unit-01-035.
7. Click the arrow to the right of the Address field to select an address
for the UCM from the list of available addresses. If you are creating
multiple UCMs, the address you select will be the first address
BMTX-SVP01A-EN 75
Configuring Tracer Summit BCU Sites
assigned. The address for each additional UCM will increase in incre-
ments of one.
8. Enter the number of UCMs of the particular type that you wish to
create in the Number to Create field.
9. To modify the security access to the UCMs, click Security Classes (see
“Setting Security Access for Objects in a Site” on page 90).
10. Click Create to create the UCMs. The Create UCM dialog box closes
and the Devices screen displays. The name of the new UCMs appear
in the UCMs in Selected Device list.
Deleting a UCM
Note:
If you have created the UCM but have not saved it in site con-
figuration, clicking Delete UCM clears the UCM from the site.
If the UCM has been saved in the site, you cannot delete the
UCM in the Site Configuration editor. Instead, use the Delete
Object utility in the Tools menu to delete the UCM. (See Chap-
ter 37, “Deleting Objects and Sites.”)
76 BMTX-SVP01A-EN
Creating, Editing, and Deleting Devices
2. Click the name of the UCM in the UCMs in Selected Device list that
you wish to delete.
3. Click the Delete UCM button.
BMTX-SVP01A-EN 77
Configuring Tracer Summit BCU Sites
78 BMTX-SVP01A-EN
Creating, Editing, and Deleting Devices
2. Click the arrow to the right of the Enhanced BCU (BMTX) Version
field or the Modular BCU (BMTW) Version field to select the version
for downloading.
Note:
On sites containing a mix of different model BCUs:
• BMTS BCUs must be at image 6.11
• BMTW BCUs (when mixed with BMTX BCUs) must be at
Version 16.00 or higher.
BMTX-SVP01A-EN 79
Configuring Tracer Summit BCU Sites
2. Type the name for the first end of billing switch in the End of Billing
1 name field.
3. Select a referencer in the Switch field. For detailed information on
referencing a property, see Chapter 4, “Using Referencer Edit Con-
trols.”
4. Repeat steps 2 and 3 for End of Billing 2 and End of Billing 3, if
desired.
80 BMTX-SVP01A-EN
Creating, Editing, and Deleting Devices
2. Type the name for the first class in the Class 1 field.
3. Repeat the previous step for each class you wish to name.
BMTX-SVP01A-EN 81
Configuring Tracer Summit BCU Sites
Note:
In the Event Routing screen of the Site Configuration editor,
only the Always, True, and False columns change when the
Event Receiver field changes.
Audible Acknowledgment
Event Class Event and Alarm Types Beep Required
82 BMTX-SVP01A-EN
Creating, Editing, and Deleting Devices
BMTX-SVP01A-EN 83
Configuring Tracer Summit BCU Sites
2. Click the arrow to the right of the Event Receiver Switch field to
select True or False, or enter a referencer (see Chapter 4, “Using Ref-
erencer Edit Controls”).
3. Click the Event Class field to Select the field.
4. Enter a label for the class in the Event Class field.
Note:
Labels for event classes one through four are pre-defined and
cannot be altered.
84 BMTX-SVP01A-EN
Creating, Editing, and Deleting Devices
Note:
Every workstation, pager, and BCU local event log defined in
the site appears in the Event Receiver list. To set up alarm
routing for each receiver, select the receiver in the Event
Receiver field, then select Always, True, or False for each event
class.
11. Click the arrow to the right of the Event Receiver field to select an
event receiver.
12. For each event receiver selected, click Always, True, or False for each
class to select the conditions under which an event message is sent.
BMTX-SVP01A-EN 85
Configuring Tracer Summit BCU Sites
86 BMTX-SVP01A-EN
Creating, Editing, and Deleting Devices
3. Click the arrow to the right of the month field to select the month.
4. Click the arrows to the right of the year field to select the year.
5. Click the date in the calendar.
6. To set the time, click the hour, minute, or second field and then click
the arrows up or down to adjust the time.
7. To set the time zone, click the Time Zone tab to display the Time Zone
screen (see Figure 82).
8. Click the arrow to the right of the time zone field to select the correct
time zone.
9. To change the default setting, click the Automatically Adjust Clock
for Daylight Saving Changes box.
10. Click OK to close the Date/Time Properties dialog box and display the
Date/Time screen.
BMTX-SVP01A-EN 87
Configuring Tracer Summit BCU Sites
2. Click the Configure button to display the Site Daylight Savings Time
dialog box (see Figure 84).
3. If the Site Daylight Savings Time fields are unavailable, click the
Enable Daylight Savings Time check box to enable the fields.
4. In the Daylight Savings Time Start fields, click the week of the month
and the day of the week on which you want daylight savings time to
start.
88 BMTX-SVP01A-EN
Creating, Editing, and Deleting Devices
5. Click the arrow to the right of the Month field to select the month in
which you want daylight savings time to start.
6. In the Standard Time Start fields, click the week of the month and
the day of the week on which you want daylight savings time to end.
7. Click the arrow to the right of the Month field to select the month in
which you want daylight savings time to end.
Note:
Only the BCU selected as the time synchronization device
should implement Daylight Savings Time adjustment.
2. To automatically align the time of all BCUs on the site with a particu-
lar device, click the Automatic Time Synchronization Enabled check
box.
3. Click the arrow to the right of the Time Synchronization Device field
to select a device to which you want to synchronize all other units.
The current time on this device will be used for synchronization when
you select Automatic Time Synchronization Enabled.
4. To synchronize devices immediately, click Synchronize Now to set all
times on the BCUs on the site (if they are communicating) to the
BMTX-SVP01A-EN 89
Configuring Tracer Summit BCU Sites
Note:
Automatic time synchronization is conducted in the early morn-
ing each day. If you want to force synchronization immediately,
click the Synchronize Now button. This process will not, how-
ever, set the time of other workstations on the site. You must
set the time for the workstation individually.
90 BMTX-SVP01A-EN
Deleting a Site
2. Click the access check boxes to allow or deny access to the object. The
security class names are defined in the Setup screen of Site Configu-
ration editor (see “Defining Security Class Names” on page 81).
3. Click OK to close the Security Classes dialog box and display the pre-
vious screen.
Deleting a Site
A site cannot be deleted from the Site Configuration editor. Use the
Delete Object utility in the Tools menu to delete a site object. (See Chap-
ter 37, “Deleting Objects and Sites.”)
BMTX-SVP01A-EN 91
Configuring Tracer Summit BCU Sites
92 BMTX-SVP01A-EN
Chapter 7
Comm5 Links
BMTX-SVP01A-EN 93
Comm5 Links
Note:
If this is a new site, choose the correct units, add your BCU and
PC workstation, and then save your site (see “Creating, Edit-
ing, and Deleting Devices” on page 57). Then proceed to step 2.
Note:
After migrating from either a BMTS or BMTW to a BMTX, you
must download the database to the BMTX before the PC Work-
station will allow you to do anything to either the Comm5 or
UCMs.
94 BMTX-SVP01A-EN
Installing a New Comm5 Link (BMTX or High Capacity BMTW)
BMTX-SVP01A-EN 95
Comm5 Links
4. Select the option next to the Comm5 link (Link 4 in Figure 89).
5. From the UCM Type drop-down list, select the type of UCM you want
to add.
6. Type a name in the UCM Address Name field.
Note:
If you are creating multiple UCMs, Tracer Summit software will use
the name you enter as the base name and follow it with the communi-
cation link number and the device number. For example, if you use
the default name “SCC” as the name for three UCMs on Link 4, the
system would name the units SCC-1-4-1, SCC-1-4-2, and SCC-1-4-3.
When doing assignments later, use the default base name if you plan
to use the location label of the device (that was set up using Rover
service tool) as the UCM object name.
7. In the Number to Create field, type the number of UCMs you want to
create.
8. Click the Create button to create the UCMs and return to the Devices
tab.
This step creates one UCM object for each of the Comm5 devices. The
list of UCMs in the UCMs in Selected Device window shows all of the
UCM objects (Figure 90). In this example, six SCC were created. Ulti-
mately, each UCM object will be connected to a Comm5 UCM through
assigning a Neuron ID.
96 BMTX-SVP01A-EN
Installing a New Comm5 Link (BMTX or High Capacity BMTW)
Note:
BMTX and high capacity BMTW BCUs will preserve bindings
only under the following conditions:
• Comm5 devices have not been installed on this BCU.
• All of the devices which have custom bindings were
either wired together at the time the bindings were
made, have always been wired together when communi-
cating with Rover since the bindings were made, and
are now all wired to the BCU.
Note:
Before proceeding, look at the Comm5 Object and Neuron
ID Summary on the right side of the dialog box to confirm
that the BCU found devices (Figure 91).
4. Click the Discover Binding button, only if bindings exist on the site.
(Since this phase of discovery can take time on a large link, it is more
efficient to omit this step if bindings don’t exist.)
In this phase of discovery, the BCU discovers bindings, verifies that
all devices have unique network addresses, and determines that there
BMTX-SVP01A-EN 97
Comm5 Links
5. To view the Discovery Details window to see if errors exist, click the
Discovery Details button (Figure 92 on page 99). If errors exist,
detailed information about them will appear in this window. If the
errors are non-critical, such as Duplicate DSNs (domain, subnet,
node) or incomplete bindings, the Fix button will be available.
6. To allow the BCU to resolve non-critical errors, click the Fix button
(see Help for more detailed information about actions taken by the
BCU). To manually resolve non-critical errors, click Help for sugges-
tions.
If critical errors exist, contact technical support and provide them
with the critical error message number to get help with resolving
them.
Note:
All errors must be resolved before installation to ensure
that bindings are saved.
If errors existed and were fixed, you will have to run the
discoveries again. After viewing the Discovery Details win-
dow, proceed to the next step.
98 BMTX-SVP01A-EN
Installing a New Comm5 Link (BMTX or High Capacity BMTW)
7. Click Save to File to save the report to a file for future reference, or
click Close to exit the Discover Details window and return to the
Assign Neuron ID dialog box.
8. After all Neuron IDs are found and errors corrected, you can begin
assigning Neuron IDs to UCM objects. From the UCM Type drop-
down list in the Assign Neuron ID dialog box, select the appropriate
UCM type.
9. From the Unassigned UCM Object Name drop-down list, select an
Unassigned UCM Object Name to give an unassigned Neuron ID to.
Note:
If you are using the location label as the object name, use the
default name that appears in the Unassigned UCM Object
Name field. For example, Figure 91 on page 98 shows
SCC-4-4-1 as the object name.
10. If you do not want to use the Neuron ID location label as the UCM
name, clear the Assign Location Label checkbox.
11. In the Neuron IDs Unassigned to UCM Objects list, select the Neuron
ID that you want associated with the UCM object displayed in the
Unassigned UCM Object Name field.
12. Click the Assign button to give the Neuron ID to the unassigned UCM
object and move it to the Neuron ID Assigned to UCM Objects list.
13. Repeat the process for the other UCM objects.
14. Click OK to return to the Devices tab. Notice that the UCMs in
Selected Device list now have Neuron IDs assigned to them.
BMTX-SVP01A-EN 99
Comm5 Links
Note:
Do not begin working on the link with the Rover service tool
until you have verified that all devices are communicating with
the BCU.
Note:
If this is a new installation, choose the correct units, add your
BCU and PC workstation, and then save your site (see “Creat-
ing, Editing, and Deleting Devices” on page 57). Then proceed
to step 2.
100 BMTX-SVP01A-EN
Installing a New Comm5 Link (Standard Capacity BMTW)
4. In the Communication Links group, choose a link and use the drop-
down arrow to access the list of communication cards. Select the
Comm5 card. (The BCU can have only one Comm5 card in any com-
munication link slot.)
5. Select a Comm5 Mode option:
• Install a new link—Select this option if you don’t have custom
bindings or don’t care if they are destroyed.
• Add to or discover existing link—Select this option if you want to
preserve custom binding.
Note:
The standard capacity BMTW BCU will preserve bindings only
under the following conditions:
• Comm5 devices have not been installed on this BCU.
• The Comm5 Mode is set to Add to or Discover existing
link.
• All of the devices which have custom bindings were
either wired together at the time the bindings were
made, have always been wired together when communi-
cating with Rover since the bindings were made, and
are now all wired to the BCU.
• RAM is cleared prior to clicking the Discover button on
the Assign Neuron ID dialog box, or pressing a service
pin on one of the new devices. Existing custom bindings
are only discovered on a RAM clear. Trane recommends
clearing RAM immediately after configuring the BCU
(see “Clearing RAM” on page 103).
6. Click OK to close the dialog box and return to the Devices tab.
7. Click Save and create Comm5 UCMs as described in Creating Comm5
UCMs Objects below.
BMTX-SVP01A-EN 101
Comm5 Links
Note:
If you are creating multiple UCMs, Tracer Summit software
will use the name you enter as the base name and follow it with
the communication link number and the device number. For
example, if you use the default name “SCC” as the name for
three UCMs on Link 4, the system would name the units SCC-
1-4-1, SCC-1-4-2, and SCC-1-4-3.
When doing assignments later, use the default base name if you
plan to use the location label of the device (that was set up
using Rover service tool) as the UCM object name.
7. In the Number to Create field, type the number of UCMs you want to
create.
8. Click the Create button to create the UCMs and return to the Devices
tab.
This step creates one UCM object for each of the Comm5 devices. The
list of UCMs in the UCMs in Selected Device window shows all of the
UCM objects (see Figure 95 on page 103). In this example, six SCCs
were created. Ultimately, each UCM object will be connected to a
Comm5 UCM through assigning a Neuron ID.
102 BMTX-SVP01A-EN
Installing a New Comm5 Link (Standard Capacity BMTW)
Clearing RAM
In order to initiate discovery by the BCU of the devices on the link and
their bindings, you need to clear RAM. Bindings will be preserved only if:
• These are the first Comm5 devices installed on the BCU.
• The Comm5 Mode in the Edit Devices dialog box is set to Add to or
discover existing link (see Figure 93).
• RAM is cleared after connecting the Comm5 link wire to the BCU.
To clear RAM:
1. From the main menu, select Tools.
2. Choose BCU Reset/Restore (see Figure 96 on page 104).
3. Choose the BCU with the Comm5 card.
4. Choose Clear Ram and Reset.
5. Click the Reset button.
BMTX-SVP01A-EN 103
Comm5 Links
104 BMTX-SVP01A-EN
Installing a New Comm5 Link (Standard Capacity BMTW)
3. To view the Discovery Details window to see if errors exist, click the
Discovery Details button (Figure 98 on page 106). If errors exist,
detailed information about them will appear in this window. If the
errors are non-critical, such as Duplicate DSNs (domain, subnet,
node) or incomplete bindings, the Fix button will be available.
4. To allow the BCU to resolve non-critical errors, click the Fix button
(see Help for more detailed information about actions taken by the
BCU). To manually resolve non-critical errors, click Help for sugges-
tions.
If critical errors exist, contact technical support and provide them
with the critical error message number to get help with resolving
them.
Note:
All errors must be resolved before installation to ensure
that bindings are saved.
If errors existed and were fixed, you will have to run the
discoveries again. After viewing the Discovery Details win-
dow, proceed to the next step.
BMTX-SVP01A-EN 105
Comm5 Links
5. Click Save to File to save the report to a file for future reference, or
click Close to exit the Discover Details window and return to the
Assign Neuron ID dialog box.
6. From the UCM Type drop-down list in the Assign Neuron ID dialog
box, select the appropriate UCM type.
7. From the Unassigned UCM Object Name drop-down list, select an
Unassigned UCM Object Name give an unassigned Neuron ID to.
Note:
If you are using the location label as the object name, use the
default name that appears in the Unassigned UCM Object
Name field. For example, Figure 97 on page 105 shows SCC-4-
4-1 as the object name.
8. If you do not want to use the Neuron ID location label as the UCM
name, clear the Assign Location Label checkbox.
9. In the Neuron IDs Unassigned to UCM Objects list, select the Neuron
ID that you want associated with the UCM object displayed in the
Unassigned UCM Object Name field.
10. Click the Assign button to give the Neuron ID to the unassigned UCM
object and move it to the Neuron ID Assigned to UCM Objects list.
11. Repeat the process for the other UCM objects.
12. Click OK to return to the Devices tab. Notice that the UCMs in
Selected Device list now have Neuron IDs assigned to them.
13. Click Save and close Site Configuration.
You can see communication established with your newly installed
devices by looking at the UCM editors. (If power is lost to the BCU
106 BMTX-SVP01A-EN
Adding a New UCM to an Existing Comm5 Link (BMTX or High Capacity BMTW)
Note:
Do not begin working on the link with the Rover service tool
until you have verified that all devices are communicating with
the BCU.
Note:
When you add a device to an existing link, you will not be able
to preserve bindings between any of the new devices that are
added. You will, however, be able to preserve existing bindings.
If additional bindings are required, create them using the
Rover service tool or Rover in Tracer Summit software, after
the device has been added. Then remove the Rover service tool
from the link and follow this procedure.
1. Start your installation at the new UCM. Configure and verify opera-
tion of the new device in stand-alone mode, without the communica-
tion link connected, using the Rover service tool.
If this device was previously installed, push the service pin for 15 sec-
onds until the red service LED flashes.
2. Connect the UCM to the communication link on the BCU. Move ter-
mination resistors, if necessary.
3. At the PC workstation select Setup from the Tracer Summit main
menu and open Site Configuration.
4. From the Devices tab, click the Create UCM button. Then follow the
procedure for “Creating Comm5 UCMs Objects for BMTX or High
Capacity BMTW” on page 95. If you created the UCMs during the ini-
tial installation, you can skip this step.
Note:
Unassigned UCMs show up in the UCMs list on the Devices
tab with the default name and no Neuron ID assigned.
5. On the Devices tab, click the Assign Neuron ID button to open the
Assign Neuron ID dialog box.
When the Assign Neuron ID dialog box opens, all command buttons
are unavailable while the PC workstation determines whether
Comm5 activity is occurring in the BCU. When there is Comm5 activ-
BMTX-SVP01A-EN 107
Comm5 Links
ity, a progress bar displays in the Comm5 Status group in the upper
right-hand corner of the dialog box. When all activity ends, the com-
mand buttons are available again.
6. Click the Discover Neuron IDs button. In this phase of discovery, the
BCU discovers devices on the link and builds a list that appears in
the Neuron IDs Unassigned to UCM Objects. Confirmation that the
BCU found devices also appears in the Comm5 Object and Neuron ID
Summary on the left side of the dialog box.
7. From the UCM Type drop-down list in the Assign Neuron ID dialog
box, select the appropriate UCM type.
8. From the Unassigned UCM Object Name drop-down list, select an
Unassigned UCM Object Name to give an unassigned Neuron ID to.
9. If you do not want to use the Neuron ID location label as the UCM
object name, clear the Assign Location Label checkbox.
10. In the Neuron IDs Unassigned to UCM Objects list, select the Neuron
ID that you want associated with the UCM object displayed in the
Unassigned UCM Object Name field.
11. Click the Assign button to give the Neuron ID to the unassigned UCM
object and move it to the Neuron ID Assigned to UCM Objects list (see
Figure 99).
108 BMTX-SVP01A-EN
Adding New UCMs to an Existing Comm5 Link (Standard Capacity BMTW)
12. Repeat the process if there are more UCM objects to assign.
13. Click OK to return to the Devices tab. Notice that the UCM objects in
Selected Device list now have Neuron IDs assigned to them.
14. Click Save and close Site Configuration.
You can see communication established with your newly installed
devices by looking at the UCM editors. (If power is lost to the BCU
before communication is established, the devices will have to be rein-
stalled.)
Note:
Do not begin working on the link with the Rover service tool
until you have verified that all devices are communicating with
the BCU.
Note:
When you add a device to an existing link, you will not be able
to preserve bindings between any of the new devices that are
added. You will, however, be able to preserve existing bindings.
If additional bindings are required, create them using the
Rover service tool or Rover in Tracer Summit software, after
the device has been added. Then remove the Rover service tool
from the link and follow this procedure.
1. Start your installation at the new Comm5 device. Configure and ver-
ify operation of the new device in stand-alone mode, without the com-
munication link connected, using the Rover service tool.
If this device was previously installed, push the service pin for 15 sec-
onds until the red service LED flashes.
2. Connect the UCM to the communication link on the BCU. Move ter-
mination resistors, if necessary.
3. When you have completed the installation of the new units on the
link, push the service pin on all of the units. This broadcasts the Neu-
ron ID of the new devices on the link. The BCU will discover only the
new devices on the link.
BMTX-SVP01A-EN 109
Comm5 Links
Note:
Unassigned UCMs show up in the UCMs list on the Devices
tab with the default name and no Neuron ID assigned.
6. On the Devices tab, click the Assign Neuron ID button to open the
Assign Neuron ID dialog box.
When the Assign Neuron ID dialog box opens, all command buttons
are unavailable while the PC workstation performs discovery of
Comm5 devices. When there is Comm5 activity, a progress bar dis-
plays in the Comm5 Status group in the upper right-hand corner of
the dialog box.
After the BCU checks for Comm5 activity, it conducts a phase 1 dis-
covery. In phase 1, the BCU discovers devices on the link and builds a
device list. You will not see a phase 2 discovery because you are not
preserving any bindings.
Once discovery is complete the command buttons become available
again and new devices will show up on the Neuron IDs Unassigned to
UCM Objects list. If devices do not show up on the list, you can click
Discover Neuron IDs to initiate a discovery.
7. From the UCM Type drop-down list in the Assign Neuron ID dialog
box, select the appropriate UCM type.
8. From the Unassigned UCM Object Name drop-down list, select an
Unassigned UCM Object Name to give an unassigned Neuron ID to.
9. If you do not want to use the Neuron ID location label as the UCM
object name, clear the Assign Location Label checkbox.
10. In the Neuron IDs Unassigned to UCM Objects field, select the Neu-
ron ID that you want associated with the UCM displayed in the Unas-
signed UCM Object Name field.
11. Click the Assign button to give the Neuron ID to the unassigned UCM
object and move it to the Neuron ID Assigned to UCM Objects list
(Figure 100 on page 111).
110 BMTX-SVP01A-EN
Adding New UCMs to an Existing Comm5 Link (Standard Capacity BMTW)
12. Repeat the process if there are more UCM objects to assign.
13. Click OK to return to the Devices tab. Notice that the UCMs in
Selected Device list now have Neuron IDs assigned to them.
14. Click Save and close Site Configuration.
You can see communication established with your newly installed
devices by looking at the UCM editors. (If power is lost to the BCU
before communication is established, the devices will have to be rein-
stalled.)
Note:
Do not begin working on the link with the Rover service tool
until you have verified that all devices are communicating with
the BCU.
BMTX-SVP01A-EN 111
Comm5 Links
Note:
When you add a device to an existing link, you will not be able
to preserve bindings between any of the new devices that are
added. You will, however, be able to preserve existing bindings.
If additional bindings are required, create them using the
Rover service tool or Rover in Tracer Summit software, after
the device has been added.
Begin the process at the Tracer Summit PC workstation. First you need
to remove the UCM that is being replaced from the assignments list in
the BCU. This tells the BCU not to look for this UCM on its Comm5 link.
To replace a Comm5 UCM:
1. Select Setup from the Tracer Summit main menu, open Site Configu-
ration and click the Devices tab.
2. On the Devices tab, click the Assign Neuron ID button. The Assign
Neuron ID dialog box displays (see Figure 101).
112 BMTX-SVP01A-EN
Replacing a Comm5 UCM
3. From the Neuron IDs Assigned to UCM objects list, choose the UCM
that is to be replaced.
4. Click the Unassign button. The UCM appears in the unassigned list
(see Figure 102).
BMTX-SVP01A-EN 113
Comm5 Links
14. Re-open Site Configuration, Devices tab, and the Assign Neuron ID
window.
15. Click the Discover Neuron IDs button. Discovery of Neuron IDs is ini-
tiated.
16. From the UCM Type drop-down list, select the UCM type. The unas-
signed UCM displays in the Unassigned UCMs field.
17. In the Neuron IDs Unassigned to UCM Objects list, select the new
Neuron ID.
18. Click the Assign button to assign the Neuron ID to the unassigned
UCM.
19. Click OK. Tracer Summit returns to the Devices tab.
20. In the UCMs in Selected Device window, verify that new Neuron ID is
in the list.
21. Click Save and close Site Configuration.
You can see communication established with your newly installed
devices by looking at the UCM editors. (If power is lost to the BCU
before communication is established, the devices will have to be rein-
stalled.)
Note:
Do not begin working on the link with the Rover service tool
until you have verified that all devices are communicating with
the BCU.
114 BMTX-SVP01A-EN
Upgrading Comm5 Database Storage for a High Capacity BMTW BCU that has
Note:
This upgrade procedure does not apply to a standard capacity
BMTW BCU, because it can store its Comm5 database only in
RAM.
If the software image has been upgraded, you will be prompted to redis-
cover the Comm5 network Neuron IDs and bindings when you log on the
PC Workstation (see Figure 103).
1. From the Setup menu, open Site Configuration and click the Devices
tab.
2. On the Devices tab, click the Assign Neuron ID button to open the
Assign Neuron ID dialog box.
BMTX-SVP01A-EN 115
Comm5 Links
When the Assign Neuron ID dialog box opens, all command buttons
are unavailable while the PC workstation determines whether
Comm5 activity is occurring in the BCU. When there is Comm5 activ-
ity, a progress bar displays in the Comm5 Status group in the upper
right-hand corner of the dialog box. When all activity ends, the com-
mand buttons are available again.
Note:
Figure 104 shows the Neuron IDs Assigned to UCM Objects list
populated. The location label column is blank because the BCU
has not discovered the actual devices on the link yet and cannot
associate the correct location label with the Neuron ID and
UCM object name. After the discovery of Neuron IDs and bind-
ings is initiated, the appropriate Neuron ID location labels will
appear.
Step 3
Note that no
location labels
are assigned.
3. Click the Discover Neuron IDs button. In this phase of discovery, the
BCU discovers devices on the link and builds a list of Neuron IDs
Unassigned to UCM Objects. Confirmation that the BCU found
devices also appears in the Comm5 Object and Neuron ID Summary
on the left side of the dialog box (Figure 97 on page 105).
4. Click the Discover Bindings button, even if you have no bindings on
the site. In this phase of discovery, the BCU will find old BCU bind-
ings, and re-establish assignments to Neuron IDs found on the link.
116 BMTX-SVP01A-EN
Upgrading Comm5 Database Storage for a High Capacity BMTW BCU that has
Notice that the location labels now appear in the Neuron IDs
Assigned to UCM Objects list (see Figure 105).
Step 4
BMTX-SVP01A-EN 117
Comm5 Links
5. Click Save to File to save the report to a file for future reference, or
click Close to exit the Discover Details window and return to the
Assign Neuron ID dialog box.
IMPORTANT
If errors exist and you click either the Cancel or the Discover Neuron
IDs button, the Comm5 database will be reset and all Neuron ID
assignments and custom bindings will be lost. If you want to con-
tinue with the upgrade, you will have to reassign all Neuron IDs and
recreate custom bindings. If you want help resolving this error, do
not click either button. Contact technical support and provide them
with the error message.
Note:
Do not begin working on the link with the Rover service tool
until you have verified that all devices are communicating with
the BCU.
118 BMTX-SVP01A-EN
Chapter 8
Note:
Tracer Summit will connect to Tracer 100 sites Version 14.4 or
higher and with Tracker sites Version 5.0 or higher. If you have
Tracer 100 or Tracker sites that predate these versions,
upgrade them with current software. Then you can communi-
cate with them using Tracer Summit Version 13 or higher.
You can communicate with Tracer 100 panels, whether they are config-
ured as unit-to-unit or not. For more information about unit-to-unit com-
munications, see Section 8 of the Tracer 100 Installation guide (EMTB-
IN-12).
BMTX-SVP01A-EN 119
Defining Tracer 100 or Tracker Sites
Note:
If the database is empty, the Restore button appears as an
option in the Select Action group. For more information on
restoring remote sites, see “Restoring a Site from the Site Cre-
ation Wizard” on page 53.
5. Click Next. The Site Connection Wizard screen appears (see Figure
108 on page 121).
120 BMTX-SVP01A-EN
Creating Tracer 100 or Tracker Sites
BMTX-SVP01A-EN 121
Defining Tracer 100 or Tracker Sites
2. Type the name of the new site in the Name of New Site field.
The new site name must be unique, one that does not exist in the
database.
3. Select Tracer 100 or Tracker from the Site Type to Copy list.
The Copy Graphics and Copy Reports check boxes are unavailable
because these items do not apply to Tracer 100 or Tracker sites.
4. Click OK. The Copy Site: Rename Panels dialog box displays (see
Figure 110 on page 123).
Note:
For Tracker sites, the New Panel Name list has one panel to
rename. Tracer 100 sites can have up to eight panels to rename.
122 BMTX-SVP01A-EN
Creating Tracer 100 or Tracker Sites
5. Type new names for the panel(s) of the new site in the New Panel
Name field.
Note:
New panel names must be unique. They cannot duplicate oth-
ers in the original site or be panel names that are in other
Tracer 100 and Tracker sites.
6. Click OK.
Tracer Summit copies the database from the original site to the new
site. The navigation tree displays the new site node, as well as any
macros associated with the original site.
BMTX-SVP01A-EN 123
Defining Tracer 100 or Tracker Sites
124 BMTX-SVP01A-EN
Configuring Tracer 100 or Tracker Panels
Figure 112. Site Configuration Editor for a Tracer 100 Series Site Screen
BMTX-SVP01A-EN 125
Defining Tracer 100 or Tracker Sites
4. Tracer 100 sites only: If the Tracer 100 panel will dial out to the
Tracer Summit workstation, type the Remote to Master Phone Num-
ber using no more than 24 characters.
The actual number dialed can consist of the numbers 0 through 9, the
# symbol, the letters w, p, and t, a single quote (for a two-second
pause), spaces, and hyphens.
Note:
The workstation uploads the remote to master phone number
from the Tracer 100 panel the first time that the Tracer 100
panel is scanned, either as part of normal processing or by Task
Manager (see Chapter 14, “Using the Task Manager”). Subse-
quent scans download the number to the panel.
2. Click the Create Remote Unit button. The Create New Device dialog
box appears (see Figure 114 on page 127).
126 BMTX-SVP01A-EN
Configuring Tracer 100 or Tracker Panels
3. Type the name of the Tracer 100 panel. This is the same name as you
would see in BMN’s Remote Unit Setup or in the file name of the
panel backup.
Note:
Since this is not a unit-to-unit, or COP, Tracer 100, leave the
Unit-to-Unit checkbox cleared. “Creating a Tracer 100 COP” on
page 129 explains how to create a unit-to-unit Tracer 100.
4. Type the unit password, if any, that is required to access the Tracer
100 panel.
The password you type must be the same as the one in the security
menu of the Tracer 100 panel.
5. Click OK. The Devices screen appears with the new device displayed
in the Remote Units list.
Note:
The Unit Type remains unknown until the Tracer 100 panel is
scanned as part of normal processing or by the Task Manager
(see Chapter 14, “Using the Task Manager”).
BMTX-SVP01A-EN 127
Defining Tracer 100 or Tracker Sites
2. In the Remote Unit Name field, type the name for the Tracker panel.
3. Click Save to store the Tracker site definition in the database.
128 BMTX-SVP01A-EN
Creating Tracer 100 Sites with Multiple Panels
Note:
All Tracer 100 panels linked to the Tracer 100 COP must have
the same software version.
Note:
Building Management Network (BMN) ends connections when
it detects mismatched site configurations, but Tracer Summit
does not. BMN displays messages such as: “A COP answered,
but is not edited as one,” or “Remote edited as a COP, but no
COP found.”
These messages do not appear in Tracer Summit. Therefore, if
you do not define additional remote panels when you should,
Tracer Summit will not allow you to connect to them in termi-
nal emulation, nor will Tracer Summit scan for them.
BMTX-SVP01A-EN 129
Defining Tracer 100 or Tracker Sites
4. In the Remote Unit Name field, type the name of the Tracer 100
panel. This is the same name as you would see in BMN Remote Unit
Setup or in the file name of the panel backup.
5. Click the Unit-to-Unit Tracer check box. The Unit Number field dis-
plays 1, which is the default number.
A COP must have a unit number of 1 in Tracer Summit, as well as on
the logic board DIP switch block.
6. In the Remote Unit Password for System Access field, type the pass-
word of the unit.
The password you type must be the same as the one given in the secu-
rity menu of the panel.
7. Click OK. The Devices screen appears. The COP appears in the
Remote Units group (see Figure 116 on page 131).
Note:
The Unit Type remains unknown until the Tracer 100 panel is
scanned as part of normal processing or by the Task Manager
(see Chapter 14, “Using the Task Manager”).
8. If you are adding remote units to the COP, perform the procedure in
“Adding Tracer 100 Panels to a Multi-Panel Site” on page 131. Other-
wise, click Save.
Note:
When you click Save, the remote device is permanently saved
in the database. This means that you cannot re-edit the unit
number of the remote unit.
130 BMTX-SVP01A-EN
Creating Tracer 100 Sites with Multiple Panels
Note:
The Unit Type remains unknown until the Tracer 100 panel is
scanned as part of normal processing or by the Task Manager
(see Chapter 14, “Using the Task Manager”).
Note:
When you click Save, the remote devices are permanently
saved in the database. This means that you cannot re-edit the
unit numbers of the remote units.
BMTX-SVP01A-EN 131
Defining Tracer 100 or Tracker Sites
132 BMTX-SVP01A-EN
Modifying Tracer 100 or Tracker Sites
BMTX-SVP01A-EN 133
Defining Tracer 100 or Tracker Sites
134 BMTX-SVP01A-EN
Deleting a Tracer 100 or Tracker Site from the System
Note:
A site must have at least one remote defined for it. If you start
with only one remote, you cannot delete the remote without
also deleting the site.
BMTX-SVP01A-EN 135
Defining Tracer 100 or Tracker Sites
136 BMTX-SVP01A-EN
Chapter 9
Each unit control module (UCM) supported in the Tracer Summit system
has an editor that allows you to create or to modify the UCM’s setup. You
access the UCM editors through the Unit Controllers menu item of the
Setup menu.
You can use UCM editors to perform these tasks:
• Create, set up, and configure a UCM on the Tracer Summit system
• View the status of a UCM
• Troubleshoot a UCM
UCM editors share common layouts and functions. This chapter describes
the typical editing tasks you can perform in UCM editors.
Note:
For detailed information about each UCM editor, refer to
Tracer Summit online help (from any UCM editor, click the
Help button or press the F1 key).
BMTX-SVP01A-EN 137
Using UCM Editors
138 BMTX-SVP01A-EN
Creating a New UCM
For both options, the New UCM Name/Address dialog box displays
(see Figure 121 on page 140).
BMTX-SVP01A-EN 139
Using UCM Editors
3. In the UCM Name field, enter a unique name for the UCM. Make the
name as informative as possible. Use a maximum of 32 characters.
You must enter a name before you can save the new UCM. You can
modify the name at any time from the Setup screen of the UCM edi-
tor.
4. In the BCU field, select a BCU. Only BCUs with compatible links are
listed.
5. In the Comm. Link field, select a communication link. Only compati-
ble links are listed.
6. In the Address field, select an address for this UCM. Only valid,
unused addresses are listed.
7. Click OK. The UCM editor specific to the UCM type you have selected
displays.
8. Set up the new UCM (see “Setting Up a UCM” on page 141).
Note:
You can not create a UCM in excess of the links capacity.
140 BMTX-SVP01A-EN
Setting Up a UCM
Setting Up a UCM
The tasks for setting up a UCM vary depending upon the UCM type. In
general, you can:
• Change the name of the UCM
• Control UCM setpoints
• Change the UCM link and address
• Select or change other setup information
You can make these changes from the UCM editor’s Setup screen. This
screen contains the fields necessary for Tracer Summit to control the
UCM. Depending on the type of UCM, there may be other dedicated
Setup tabs for specific UCM functions. For detailed information on the
fields of the Setup screen, click the Help button.
To set up a UCM:
1. From the UCM editor, click the Setup tab. Figure 122 shows an exam-
ple Setup screen. The fields vary depending upon the UCM type.
BMTX-SVP01A-EN 141
Using UCM Editors
Configuring a UCM
Most UCM editors have a Configuration screen where you can set UCM
configuration information. Because this information is stored locally in
the UCM, you cannot edit the information on the Configuration screen
when the UCM is offline. For detailed information on the fields of the
Configuration screen, click the Help button.
To configure a UCM:
1. From the UCM editor, click the Configuration tab. Figure 123 shows
an example Configuration screen. The fields vary depending upon the
UCM type.
142 BMTX-SVP01A-EN
Setting Overrides for a UCM
2. Click the Override button. The Override dialog box displays with
Change Value To selected (see Figure 125 on page 144).
Note:
If you need help with overrides, click the Tutorial button (see
Figure 125 on page 144) to open the Tracer Summit Daily Oper-
ations Tutorial.
BMTX-SVP01A-EN 143
Using UCM Editors
3. In the Change Value To list box, select the desired value. For a UCM,
the available values are: Unoccupied, Optimal Stop, Occupied, Opti-
mal Start, Demand Limit, Duty Cycle, Priority Shutdown, Night
Economize, and Night Heat/Cool.
4. Click the At Priority list box to select a priority.
5. Click Apply to perform the override. The Priority Array list updates.
6. Click OK to close the Override dialog box.
144 BMTX-SVP01A-EN
Routing Alarms and Events and Setting Security Access
2. In the Control Class field, select a control class. The control class
defines the event class that will receive an event message when the
present value of the UCM changes.
3. In each diagnostic field in the Alarm Classes group, select an appro-
priate event class for routing alarms.
BMTX-SVP01A-EN 145
Using UCM Editors
3. Click on the Access field next to each class to grant or deny access to
the security class. A check in the field grants access. If unchecked,
permission to the security class is denied.
4. Click OK to close the Change Security Classes dialog box.
Deleting a UCM
You cannot delete a UCM from a UCM editor. Use the Delete Object func-
tion from the Tools menu to delete a UCM (see Chapter 37, “Deleting
Objects and Sites”).
146 BMTX-SVP01A-EN
Chapter 10
BMTX-SVP01A-EN 147
Setting Up Printers, Modems, and Pagers
Setting Up Printers
In Tracer Summit, you can print graphics, reports and CPL programs, as
well as the event log and alarms and events as they occur. For graphics,
reports, CPL programs, and the entire event log, you can select the File
menu’s Print item to print the displayed information. These items use
page printing, which prints a page at a time to a printer. For page print-
ing, you can use any standard printer (such as a laser or inkjet printer).
You set up and use the printer just as you do from any Windows program.
Event and alarm printing is handled differently. Tracer Summit prints
alarms and events to a selected events printer one line at a time as they
occur. A tractor-feed (or line-feed) printer works best as the events printer
so that you can view the events as they are generated and printed. If you
select a page printer, you do not see the events until a complete page is
printed. Typically, the events printer is connected directly to the PC
Workstation (on the LPT1: port). However, the printer can also be con-
nected through a network.
To print the entire event log, you can use any printer. The events printer
is only for printing alarms and events one at a time as they occur.
Whether you are setting up the events printer or any other printers, you
need to first add the printer in the Windows operating system.
148 BMTX-SVP01A-EN
Setting Up Modems
Setting Up Modems
Tracer Summit software supports modem communications between a
BCU and a remote PC Workstation. Once the BCU and PC Workstation
modems are installed, you can set up and configure both modems in
Tracer Summit using the Workstation or BCU Modem editor.
In the Tracer 100/Tracker Communications package, Tracer Summit sup-
ports modem communication between Tracer 100 or Tracker (EMTK)
panels and a remote PC Workstation.
You add BCU modems during site configuration (see “Adding a BCU
Modem” on page 60). Once a BCU modem is configured, you can then
modify the modem through the modem editor.
You add and configure workstation modems for BCU sites and for Tracer
100 or Tracker (EMTK) sites through the modem editor.
2. Select a modem and click OK. The Workstation Modem editor dis-
plays (see Figure 129 on page 150).
BMTX-SVP01A-EN 149
Setting Up Printers, Modems, and Pagers
Modems
Icon
150 BMTX-SVP01A-EN
Setting Up Modems
BMTX-SVP01A-EN 151
Setting Up Printers, Modems, and Pagers
2. Click New. The New Modem Name dialog box displays (see
Figure 132).
152 BMTX-SVP01A-EN
Setting Up Modems
Note:
The comm port in the BMTS BCU has a fixed speed of 9600
baud. The BMTW BCU has an adjustable speed up to 38400
baud. So, depending on what type of BCU you are calling, as
well as the quality of the phone line, you might be able to use
the higher baud rate.
BMTX-SVP01A-EN 153
Setting Up Printers, Modems, and Pagers
2. Select the baud rate from the Workstation Comm Port Maximum
Speed list.
Note:
The Configuration Strings fields display default modem com-
mand strings. However, you can edit the fields to accommodate
specific modem requirements. For information about changing
default settings, refer to the Tracer Summit online Help.
154 BMTX-SVP01A-EN
Setting Up Modems
Note:
The Configuration Strings fields display default modem com-
mand strings. However, you can edit the fields to accommodate
specific modem requirements. To connect to Tracer 100 or
Tracker sites, it is very important to include commands to dis-
able error correction and data compression in the initialization
string fields. For information about changing default settings,
refer to the Tracer Summit online Help.
BMTX-SVP01A-EN 155
Setting Up Printers, Modems, and Pagers
Note:
• You will not be able to select a communications port that is
being used by another workstation modem.
• If you edit this field for an existing workstation modem,
Tracer Summit continues to use the previous value until
you restart Tracer Summit.
5. From the Modem Usage list, select the option that best fits how the
modem is to be used. For information on making your selection, see
Table 4 on page 157.
156 BMTX-SVP01A-EN
Setting Up Modems
Use this
Modem Modem for
Usage T100/ Result
Tracker
Sites
(1) There is no setting to exclude BCU sites from using the modem as there
is for Tracer 100 and Tracker sites (see the Use this Modem for T100/Tracker
Sites check box discussed in “Configuring a Workstation Modem for Tracer
100 or Tracker Sites” on page 154). However, to exclude incoming calls: pro-
gram your remote BCU sites to call a different phone number than the one
your remote Tracer 100 and Tracker sites call.
(2) To communicate with Tracer 100 and Tracker panels, you must initialize
the modem so that data compression and error control are disabled.
BMTX-SVP01A-EN 157
Setting Up Printers, Modems, and Pagers
2. Select a modem and click OK. The BCU Modem editor displays (see
Figure 138).
158 BMTX-SVP01A-EN
Setting Up Modems
2. Select model of modem you have installed in the BCU from the Con-
nect By list. This does not apply to the BMTX because there is only
one model of modem available.
3. In the Maximum Dialing Attempts field, enter the number of times
the BCU will attempt to connect with a remote PC Workstation or
pager.
Note:
If the number of dialing attempts is greater than one, the BCU
will wait five minutes before each attempt to dial the number
again.
BMTX-SVP01A-EN 159
Setting Up Printers, Modems, and Pagers
2. From the BMTW BCU Comm Port Maximum Speed list, select the
baud rate that best matches the speed of the modem you have
installed in the BCU.
The comm port in the BMTX and BMTW BCU has an adjustable
speed setting. This is because modems are gaining in speed and phone
lines are clearer, so the speeds at which a workstation or BCU modem
can connect is increasing as well. To maximize the rate that data can
be transferred between the BCU modem and the BCU, set the speed
of the comm port to its maximum value.
Note:
For CE certification, special initialization strings must be used
based on the international location. See online help for specific
configuration information.
The Configuration Strings fields display default modem com-
mand strings. However, you can edit the fields to accommodate
specific modem requirements.
160 BMTX-SVP01A-EN
Setting Up Modems
BMTX-SVP01A-EN 161
Setting Up Printers, Modems, and Pagers
4. In the Dialing Prefix field, enter a dialing prefix to be used with all
phone numbers defined in the phone book (if applicable).
Note:
When dialing out on the modem, the total combined character
lengths of the dialing string cannot exceed the manufacturer’s
recommended maximum length. The dialing string for worksta-
tions is comprised of the dialing command (ATDT), the dialing
prefix, phone number, and calling card number. The dialing
string for BCUs is the same as the workstations except that the
BCU might also have a numeric message for digital (numeric)
pagers. The sequence in which the dial string is sent in the
order listed above.
5. In the Calling Card field, enter a long distance calling card number
that can be used with the defined phone number.
Note:
Depending on the calling card, a short pause or second dial tone
may be required before dialing the calling card number. Use
commas to define a pause (for example: ,,,821-163-2288-6576)
Use a W to make the modem wait for a second dial tone (for
example: W 825-163-2288-6576).
162 BMTX-SVP01A-EN
Setting Up Modems
BMTX-SVP01A-EN 163
Setting Up Printers, Modems, and Pagers
3. Click on the Access field next to each class to grant or deny access. A
check in the field grants access. No check denies access.
4. Click OK to display the Classes screen.
164 BMTX-SVP01A-EN
Setting Up Pagers
Setting Up Pagers
Tracer Summit software supports communication between a BCU and a
pager. The BCU (equipped with a modem) sends messages to the pager
using a paging service. Tracer Summit uses paging to notify you of alarms
in the system.
Note:
See Chapter 6, “Configuring Tracer Summit BCU Sites”, for
details on how to assign a pager as an event receiver
2. Select a pager and click OK. The Pager editor Setup screen displays
(see Figure 147).
BMTX-SVP01A-EN 165
Setting Up Printers, Modems, and Pagers
2. Click New. The New Pager Name dialog box displays (see Figure 149).
166 BMTX-SVP01A-EN
Setting Up Pagers
Setting Up a Pager
1. From the Pager editor, display the Setup screen (see Figure on page
166).
2. In the Pager Protocol field, select the type of pager format the BCU
will use to dial out alarms (either Alpha-Numeric ‘TAP” or Digital
‘Numeric Only’).
Note:
If you select Alpha-Numeric ‘TAP, the paging service must sup-
port the TAP communications protocol.
3. Make a selection:
• If the Alpha-Numeric ‘TAP’ button is selected, enter the telephone
number of the pager in the Pager ID (PIN) field.
• If the Digital ‘Numeric Only’ button is selected, enter a numeric
code in the Message field. The code should be meaningful to the
receiver.
BMTX-SVP01A-EN 167
Setting Up Printers, Modems, and Pagers
3. Click on the Access field next to each class to grant or deny access. A
check in the field grants access. No check denies access.
4. Click OK to display the Classes screen.
168 BMTX-SVP01A-EN
Setting Up Security—Tracer Summit System
Chapter 11
Setting Up Security—Tracer
Summit System
Note:
The Tracer Summit system allows you to delete the tracer user
name only after a security supervisor has been created on the
system and that supervisor has logged on.
BMTX-SVP01A-EN 169
Setting Up Security—Tracer Summit System
Operator
Level Example Operators Security Access
When setting up a new user, you can choose from the predefined profiles,
or you can create a custom profile. You can also copy the profile from a
previously defined user.
Note:
Based on the profile you select when you create a user, access
may be pre-selected for some objects. If you are creating a cus-
tom profile, no access is pre-selected.
170 BMTX-SVP01A-EN
Setting Up Security—Tracer Summit System
2. Click New. The User Setup dialog box displays (see Figure 154).
BMTX-SVP01A-EN 171
Setting Up Security—Tracer Summit System
4. Select an option:
• If you wish to use a predefined operator level profile or customize
a predefined operator level profile for security access, click the
name in the Selected Profile box, then click OK to display the
Security editor User Info screen (see Figure 156 on page 173).
Proceed to step 9.
• If you wish to copy the operator level profile of an existing user,
click Copy From to display the Copy From dialog box (see
Figure 155). Proceed to step 5.
172 BMTX-SVP01A-EN
Setting Up Security—Tracer Summit System
8. At the Security editor User Info screen, enter a First name in the
First Name field (1–28 characters) and a Last Name in the Last
Name field (1–29 characters). Entries in the Middle field (0–4 charac-
ters) and Job Title field (0–30 characters) are optional.
9. Enter a password in the Password field. Use up to eight characters.
The password displays as asterisks (*).
Note:
• When setting up multiple sites, an operator can be auto-
matically logged on to all sites. For this to work, you need to
enter the same user name and password for all sites that
the user needs access to.
• When creating the password for the first time, click the
Show Password check box to verify the password entry.
After checking for mistakes, deselect Show Password to
convert the password back to asterisks (*).
BMTX-SVP01A-EN 173
Setting Up Security—Tracer Summit System
10. In the Options fields, click the following to select or deselect the
option:
• Security Supervisor
• Match Upper & Lower Case
• Automatic Remote Connect
• Disconnect Remote Connection at Log Off
• Auto-Log Off
Note:
We recommend you select Auto-Log Off. If a user leaves a PC
Workstation unattended, Tracer Summit logs the user off auto-
matically after the number of minutes specified in the Minutes
field.
11. If you select Auto-Log Off, in the Minutes field type in the number of
minutes of non-activity before the system logs off the user.
12. Click the check box in the Access column to grant or deny access for
each function.
174 BMTX-SVP01A-EN
Setting Up Security—Tracer Summit System
2. Click the check box in the View Only column or in the View/Edit col-
umn for each application to grant or deny access to that application.
2. Click the check box in the Access column to grant or deny access for
each object.
BMTX-SVP01A-EN 175
Setting Up Security—Tracer Summit System
2. Click the check box in the Read Only column or in the Read/Write col-
umn for each class to grant or deny access to that class.
176 BMTX-SVP01A-EN
Setting Up Group Security
Note:
Do not remove or change the name of the Nobody Logged On
user. The system requires this user name to operate properly.
Note:
If you removed the Tracer Summit user from site security, you
have to temporarily re-create this user to log on to a site and
access group security. After you create a new level 2 security
user, you can then delete the Tracer Summit user.
BMTX-SVP01A-EN 177
Setting Up Security—Tracer Summit System
3. Click New. The Group User Setup dialog box appears (see
Figure 163).
178 BMTX-SVP01A-EN
Setting Up Group Security
Note:
As a default, the Tracer Summit software masks the password
from onlookers and all characters in the field display as aster-
isks. Click the Show Password check box to display the pass-
word without asterisks.
BMTX-SVP01A-EN 179
Setting Up Security—Tracer Summit System
180 BMTX-SVP01A-EN
Deleting a User
Note:
Some of the setup activities are always available.
6. Click Save.
Deleting a User
You cannot delete a user from the Security editor. To delete a user, use the
Delete Object utility in the Tools menu..
Note:
Deleting a user from group security does not delete the user
from site security. This applies to site and group security.
BMTX-SVP01A-EN 181
Setting Up Security—Tracer Summit System
182 BMTX-SVP01A-EN
Chapter 12
Grouping sites allow you to quickly and easily service and monitor large
numbers of sites. Creating groups is a feature that comes with the Enter-
prise Management package.
With grouping capabilities, you can group sites together and edit sched-
ules or change setpoints once for the group. This saves time because you
do not have to make the same edit for each site. In addition, with Tracer
Summit grouping functions, you can:
• Put a site in multiple groups.
• Perform global changes to the groups. These changes can affect all
sites in the group.
• Use Task Manager to schedule a scan of groups of sites rather than
scheduling individual site scans.
• Use message forwarding and call centers to organize message for-
warding by site groups rather than individual sites.
Note:
Group configuration does not appear as a selection on the Setup
menu unless you have both site security and group security
access. For more information about group security, see “Setting
Up Group Security” on page 155.
BMTX-SVP01A-EN 183
Creating Groups of Sites
Creating a Group
Use Group Configuration to put sites into groups. You can also include
groups of sites within groups.
Note:
You must create sites before you can add or create groups (see
“Creating a Site” on page 34).
To create a group:
1. From the Setup menu, select Group Configuration. The Select Group
dialog box displays (see Figure 166).
184 BMTX-SVP01A-EN
Modifying Groups
Note:
Groups of sites display in the Available site(s) list with a “(g)”
prefix.
Modifying Groups
After you create a group, any changes that you make to this group are
made to all of the site(s) or group(s) of sites in the group.
To modify groups:
1. From the Group Configuration dialog box:
• Click Add to add selected members to the Selected Site(s) list
• Click Remove to remove selected members from the Selected
Site(s) list
2. Click Save to save the new group to the database.
3. Click Close.
Sample Scenarios
The following scenarios show how you might use groups to make global
changes.
Scenario 1
As a building manager for a school district you have to override all of the
schedules for 15 schools because of weather. To do this, you access the
Time of Day application and click the Group Select button. You specify
the “All Buildings” group and select all of the affected schedules. After
you click OK, the global changes editor for time of day appears.
In the editor, you remove all of the start events for the day and click the
Save As Exception button. When the Download Scheduler dialog box
appears, you download the changes to the sites immediately. The work-
BMTX-SVP01A-EN 185
Creating Groups of Sites
station scans all of the sites in the database to download the schedule
exceptions for that day.
Scenario 2
As a manager of several stores you need to change the cooling setpoint for
the offices in all your stores. You select Area from the Setup menu, then
click Group Select on the Select Area dialog box. You select the All Stores
group and select all the office areas. After you click OK, the global
changes editor for Area appears. On the Setup screen you change the
occupied cooling setpoint and save your changes. In the Download Sched-
uler dialog box you schedule the changes to download that night at
2:00 a.m. Later the next morning, the workstation begins a scan task at
2:00 a.m., scanning all of the sites to download the area setpoint change.
Deleting Groups
Use the Delete Objects utility to delete a group or groups. For more infor-
mation on using the utility, see “Deleting a Site” on page 606.
186 BMTX-SVP01A-EN
Chapter 13
To make global changes, you select multiple objects of the same type and
edit them simultaneously with the editor for that object type. For exam-
ple, you can select specific schedules in groups of sites and edit all the
schedules in the schedule editor.
Making changes to single sites is part of the Tracer Summit standard
software. Making global changes to groups of sites is part of the Enter-
prise Management package.
Using the global change function editor of the object editor, you can
quickly and simply change many objects in a single site or across numer-
ous sites that are part of groups. The following types of objects allow glo-
bal changes:
• Area
• Binary inputs/outputs
• Analog inputs/outputs
• Time of Day schedules (BCU and Tracer 100)
• Calculated binaries (type 08 points), see “Viewing and Modifying
BCU Objects” on page 191
• Calculated analogs (type 11 points), see “Viewing and Modifying BCU
Objects” on page 191
• Thermostat control modules
• Voyager rooftops
• VAV II/III/IV
BMTX-SVP01A-EN 187
Making Global Changes
4. Click OK. The editor of the object type you selected displays.
5. In the editor, change the desired properties of the object.
For example, from the Binary Output editor, click the Setup tab and
change the On State Label from On to Enable.
6. Click Save. The editor saves the changes to the objects you selected in
step 3. The Save Successful dialog box displays.
7. Click OK in the Save Successful to return to the editor.
188 BMTX-SVP01A-EN
Applying Global Changes to Multiple Sites
4. In the Available Groups field, select the desired group. The Available
Objects list displays all the Voyager rooftops that are in the sites
which are members of the specified group.
Note:
To sort the object list alphanumerically by object name, click
the Object header.
BMTX-SVP01A-EN 189
Making Global Changes
5. In the Available Objects in the Group list, select the desired object(s).
6. Click Add to add the object(s) to the Objects selected for editing list.
7. Click OK. The editor for the object type displays.
8. Click the Setup tab.
9. Change any available attribute of the object.
10. Click Save. The Global Changes - Schedule Download dialog box dis-
plays (see Figure 170).
Note:
When you define a download time, it does not simply download
the most recent changes. It also downloads any other changes
that you made to the database.
12. Click OK. The changes will be sent to the database at the time you
designated. The Save Successful dialog box displays.
Note:
To verify that the changes downloaded successfully, check the
error log.
13. Click OK on the Save Successful dialog box to return to the editor.
190 BMTX-SVP01A-EN
Viewing and Modifying BCU Objects
Note:
To change objects across multiple sites, you must have installed
the Enterprise Management package.
You can view these objects online or offline in the editors. You can modify
them online or upload them to your workstation and then modify them
through the appropriate editor.
Note:
Task Manager schedules scans, and during this process
uploads and downloads the correct items.
BMTX-SVP01A-EN 191
Making Global Changes
192 BMTX-SVP01A-EN
Viewing and Modifying BCU Objects
Note:
When performing a global change across multiple sites you can
override an object at the priority level selected in the At Prior-
ity drop-down list, even if your site level security does not allow
access to priority level.
5. Click the Override button. The Override Object dialog box appears
(see Figure 174 on page 194).
BMTX-SVP01A-EN 193
Making Global Changes
Note:
The analog or binary output objects may not control to your
modification if the object is being controlled at a higher priority
than the one you select.
194 BMTX-SVP01A-EN
Viewing and Modifying BCU Objects
Note:
If you make the change offline, you must connect to the BCU
panel for the modification to take effect.
BMTX-SVP01A-EN 195
Making Global Changes
Note:
To change objects across multiple sites, you must have installed
the Enterprise Management package.
You can view these objects online or offline in the editors with the termi-
nal emulation screen (see the section on terminal emulation in the Daily
Operations guide). You can modify them online or upload them to your
workstation and then modify them through the appropriate editor.
Calculated binary and analog objects are only used by Tracer 100 series
panels. Calculated binaries (point type 08) and calculated analogs (point
type 11) are similar to binary and analog inputs/outputs, but they are not
associated with hardware. See Tracer 100 Series Programming Guide
(EMTB-PG-11) for more information about calculated binaries and ana-
logs.
Note:
Task Manager schedules scans, and during this process
uploads downloads the correct items.
196 BMTX-SVP01A-EN
Viewing and Modifying Calculated Analog and Binary Objects
BMTX-SVP01A-EN 197
Making Global Changes
5. Click the Override button. The Override Object dialog box displays
(see Figure 174 on page 194).
198 BMTX-SVP01A-EN
Viewing and Modifying Calculated Analog and Binary Objects
BMTX-SVP01A-EN 199
Making Global Changes
• If you make the change while connected to the Tracer 100, the
change is immediately sent to the panel.
• If you make the change offline, you must connect to the panel for
the modification to take effect, (see “Uploading and Downloading
BCU Objects” on page 191).
200 BMTX-SVP01A-EN
Chapter 14
Task Manager helps you automate tasks to reduce the time it takes to
maintain a site or groups of sites. Task Manager lets you schedule BCU,
Tracer 100, or Tracker site backups, archive the event log, or scan sites to
occur whenever your workstation is on.
With Task Manager, you can change site information offline and schedule
these changes to download to specific sites or groups at night, when tele-
phone rates are low. If you have a large number of sites that require
extensive changes, you can schedule these for non-work hours, saving this
time for other duties.
The Task Manager is part of the Building Management and Enterprise
Management packages. These add-ons to Tracer Summit enable you to
create tasks for hundreds or even thousands of separate sites from a cen-
tral location.
The Task Manager lets you:
• Download during a scan the offline global changes that you made to
any of the site types
• Schedule automatic scans for BCU sites, as well as Tracer 100 and
Tracker sites (if you have the Tracer 100/Tracker Communication
package).
• Schedule site backups that you can use to restore sites at a later date
• Schedule regular archives of the workstation event log
• Edit existing tasks to modify schedules, actions, or site members
• Schedule one-time events or repeating tasks
• Initiate manual scans on the site you are connected to
• Log scan errors in Task Log. (For more information, see the sections
on the event log in the Daily Operations guide)
• Perform operations on the workstation while scans and other tasks
are being run
BMTX-SVP01A-EN 201
Using the Task Manager
Backing Up Sites
Task Manager performs immediate or scheduled backups of BCU and
Tracer 100. This function makes a copy of the information from your
workstation database for BCU or Tracer 100 sites. A BDB file is created
for each of the selected sites.
The backup files can be saved to any location that you specify.
Scanning Sites
During a site scan, Tracer Summit connects to a site and downloads
changes to the site and collects information from the site.
Note:
The Tracer Summit site scan is similar to the scan function of
Building Management Network (BMN) software. Task Man-
ager, however, does not perform the reporting functions during
scans that BMN software does.
Task Manager can scan Tracer Summit BCU sites, as well as Tracer 100
and Tracker sites (if you have the Tracer 100/Tracker Communication
package).
During a site scan, Tracer Summit uploads or downloads site informa-
tion. For BCU sites, Task Manager uploads all object types. For Tracer
100 or Tracker sites, Task Manager uploads schedules, alarms, holidays,
and calculated binary/analog objects.
During a site scan, Task Manager also determines whether you have
made offline changes to the site. If you have changed a site’s information
at the workstation, Task Manager downloads this information to the
202 BMTX-SVP01A-EN
Defining the Four Tasks
panel first. If you have not made offline changes, Task Manager uploads
the panel information.
Panel Backups
During a panel backup, Tracer Summit connects to Tracer 100 sites and
creates a backup file of the panel’s database. If a Tracer 100 site has mul-
tiple panels linked to it, Tracer Summit creates separate .SAV files for
each panel.
Note:
If you want to back up individual panels of a site, use the
Backup a Remote selection from the Setup menu. For more
information, see “Creating .SAV files for Tracer 100 Panels” on
page 394.
This backup creates a .SAV file, which you can use to restore the panel
(see “Restoring a Tracer 100 Panel” on page 616). You cannot, however,
use this file to restore the panel information to your workstation data-
base. You can only use .BDB files to restore site information to the work-
station database.
BMTX-SVP01A-EN 203
Using the Task Manager
204 BMTX-SVP01A-EN
Run Immediate Scan on a Single Site
Note:
For more information about running an immediate scan on
groups of sites after making global changes, see “Applying Glo-
bal Changes to Multiple Sites” on page 189.
BMTX-SVP01A-EN 205
Using the Task Manager
To access the Scan Status dialog box, double-click the blue box on the
status bar. The Scan Progress dialog box appears.
Note:
To verify that the changes downloaded successfully, check the
error log.
206 BMTX-SVP01A-EN
Creating a Task for a Single Site
• On the time interval screen, select the start time, time interval,
and effective period
Note:
“Every 1 weeks” means every week. “Every 2 weeks” means
every other week, and so on.
BMTX-SVP01A-EN 207
Using the Task Manager
208 BMTX-SVP01A-EN
Creating a Task for a Single Site
Note:
The task does not appear in the Task Manager Schedule until
you click Save. To verify that the changes downloaded success-
fully, check the error log.
BMTX-SVP01A-EN 209
Using the Task Manager
Note:
See Chapter 13, “Making Global Changes” for procedures for
global changes and scheduling them to be downloaded to groups
of sites.
With the Task Schedule Wizard, you specify the start time and date of the
task. You can schedule a task as a once-only task, or schedule it to occur
on a daily, weekly, monthly, or other specified time interval.
To create a scan task for groups of sites:
1. Repeat steps 1 through 10 in “Creating a Task for a Single Site” on
page 206.
2. In the Available Site(s) list, select the sites and/or groups that you are
creating the task for.
Note:
When you assign a group to a scheduled task, all sites that are
members of the group when the task runs are included in the
task. Use the Group Configuration dialog box to add or remove
sites from the group after you have created the task (see “Creat-
ing a Group” on page 184). In this way, sites that are added to a
group after you schedule the group for a task are included when
the task runs.
3. Click Add to add the sites and/or groups to the Selected Site(s) list.
4. Click OK. The Task Setup dialog box closes and the Task Manager
Schedule displays.
5. Click Save. The new task is saved to the workstation database and
displays in the Task Manager Schedule.
At the scheduled time, the task runs.
Note:
The task does not appear in the task manager schedule until
you click Save. To verify that the changes downloaded success-
fully, check the error log.
210 BMTX-SVP01A-EN
Modifying Tasks
Modifying Tasks
Use the following procedures to modify Tracer Summit tasks created with
Task Manager.
Editing a Task
1. From the Task Manager Schedule, double-click the task you want to
edit in the Task Manager Schedule. The Task Setup dialog box dis-
plays the description, schedule, task actions and site assignments for
the edited task.
2. From this screen, you can perform the following:
• Change the description for the task
• Click Edit Schedule to modify the timing of the task
• Select different tasks and/or task options
• Add and/or remove sites from the scheduled task
3. After you edit the task, click OK to display the Task Manager Sched-
ule.
4. Click Save. The edited task is saved to the workstation database and
displays in the Task Manager Schedule.
Deleting a Task
1. From the Task Manager Schedule, click the task you want to delete in
the Task Manager Schedule view. The selected task is highlighted.
2. Press the Delete key.
3. Click Save. The task you selected and all further occurrences of it are
removed from the system.
BMTX-SVP01A-EN 211
Using the Task Manager
2. Click the button with three dots. The Archive Options dialog box
appears (see Figure 185).
212 BMTX-SVP01A-EN
Specifying Where to Save a Backup File
2. Click the button with three dots. The Site Backup Options dialog box
appears.
Note:
When changing Panel Backup options, the Site Backup Options
dialog box appears (see Figure 187).
3. In the Path field, specify the folder on your hard drive where you
want to save the file.
Click the Browse button to select a path using the Microsoft Browse
for Folder dialog box.
4. Click OK to save your changes.
5. Continue programming the task.
Note:
The default save location for backup files is the
\Tracer Summit\Backup directory.
BMTX-SVP01A-EN 213
Using the Task Manager
214 BMTX-SVP01A-EN
Chapter 15
Note:
Tracer 100 and Tracker sites are available when you have the
Tracer 100/Tracker Communications package installed, as well
as either the Building Management or Enterprise Management
packages.
Note:
Once set up, message forwarding and call centers work in the
background. Message forwarding will send out alarm messages
even when you are not logged onto a site, but, Tracer Summit
must be running, and your PC must be logged in to your com-
pany’s mail server or your PC modem line must not be busy.
BMTX-SVP01A-EN 215
Message Forwarding and Call Centers
Background Considerations
Important issues you should remember when setting up message for-
warding and call centers for Tracer Summit BCU, Tracer 100, and
Tracker sites are the setup processes for message forwarding and call cen-
ters, as well as preliminary setup issues.
216 BMTX-SVP01A-EN
Background Considerations
profile to keep personal items secure. Tracer Summit uses the profile
to send alarms to the mail server.
• Set up e-mail message forwarding—This includes setting up the
call center and recipient in the Tracer Summit software. While the
facility is unattended, you can send pager alarms that originate from
sites as e-mails to on-call recipients.
• The call center forwarding schedule displays the times when the
call center forwards alarms to various recipients by means of
their e-mail addresses. A typical schedule for alarm forwarding is
between 5 p.m. to 8 a.m., Monday to Friday, and all day on week-
ends and holidays.
• The recipient on-call schedule is the time when an on-call recipi-
ent receives the e-mails. In a typical work situation, recipients
are on-call on a rotating basis. When setting up a call center,
make sure that the unattended hours of the facilities are covered.
• In Figure 188 on page 218, the Select Sites/Groups and Event
Classes/Priorities boxes represent steps in which you specify
which sites or groups and what alarms need to be forwarded.
Besides sites and groups, you can schedule alarms for BCU event
classes and alarm priorities for Tracer 100 or Tracker panels.
IMPORTANT
Your workstation must be set up as an event receiver in BCU sites, with
a telephone number defined in Tracer 100 and Tracker sites, and other
requirements for alarms must be satisfied, as described in Chapter 6,
“Configuring Tracer Summit BCU Sites.”
BMTX-SVP01A-EN 217
Message Forwarding and Call Centers
Select Sites/
Groups
Select Alarm
Priorities
Setup
Complete
218 BMTX-SVP01A-EN
Background Considerations
BMTX-SVP01A-EN 219
Message Forwarding and Call Centers
220 BMTX-SVP01A-EN
Setting Up Call Centers and Message Forwarding
BMTX-SVP01A-EN 221
Message Forwarding and Call Centers
Note:
To save a call center you must first add recipients and schedule
when they should receive e-mails.
222 BMTX-SVP01A-EN
Setting Up Call Centers and Message Forwarding
BMTX-SVP01A-EN 223
Message Forwarding and Call Centers
224 BMTX-SVP01A-EN
Setting Up Call Centers and Message Forwarding
5. Click OK.
BMTX-SVP01A-EN 225
Message Forwarding and Call Centers
Note:
It doesn’t matter which call center you are in when you add
dates to the list, the date will become a holiday for all call cen-
ters. However, each call center can decide whether to observe
the holiday dates or not, depending on whether the Send e-mail
checkbox is checked or unchecked.
226 BMTX-SVP01A-EN
Setting Up Call Centers and Message Forwarding
To remove holidays
1. Click the Edit button to display the Select Dates dialog box.
2. From the Selected Dates list, select the holiday you want to remove.
3. Click the Remove Date button to delete the date.
4. Click Save to save your changes.
5. Click Okay to return to the editor.
Note:
The holiday date is removed from all call centers.
Note:
If you check this box, the call center will send e-mail on all holi-
days displayed in the list box. If you leave this box unchecked,
no e-mail will be sent on any of the holidays.
Note:
Disabling the holidays only applies to the currently open call
center. To disable holidays for other call centers, open each one
individually and repeat step 1 above.
BMTX-SVP01A-EN 227
Message Forwarding and Call Centers
228 BMTX-SVP01A-EN
Setting Up Call Centers and Message Forwarding
4. Click Save.
BMTX-SVP01A-EN 229
Message Forwarding and Call Centers
IMPORTANT
The event class names in the Event Classes screen do not update to
match the event class names that you might have entered in site con-
figuration (see “Example of User-Defined Event Classes” on page 83).
3. If you have Tracer sites selected, click the Tracer Priority alarms.
4. If you have Tracker sites selected, click the Tracker Priority alarms.
230 BMTX-SVP01A-EN
Modifying Call Centers
Note:
If you try to delete a call center that is currently open, a warn-
ing message displays. It explains that the editor will shut down
if you delete the call center.
BMTX-SVP01A-EN 231
Message Forwarding and Call Centers
232 BMTX-SVP01A-EN
Chapter 16
Creating Input/Output
Objects
Input objects are used to generate alarms. Output objects are used to con-
trol devices and maintain calculated values for CPL routines. There are
four types of input/output (I/O) objects:
• Analog input
• Binary input
• Analog output
• Binary output
The Tracer Summit system can simultaneously monitor hundreds of ana-
log and binary inputs and outputs from every part of a facility.
Note:
Properties of objects can be viewed and controlled directly from
a graphic or other application without the use of an I/O object.
I/O objects are value for:
• Alarming
• Tracking changes in the Event Log
• Sharing data with other BACnet devices.
BMTX-SVP01A-EN 233
Creating Input/Output Objects
3. Click New. The New Analog Input Name dialog box displays (see
Figure 200).
4. Enter a name for the input. Make the name as informative as possi-
ble. Use a maximum of 32 characters.
5. Click OK. The Analog Input editor displays (see Figure 201 on page
235).
234 BMTX-SVP01A-EN
Creating an Analog Input
6. Click the Setup tab to display the Setup screen (see Figure 202).
BMTX-SVP01A-EN 235
Creating Input/Output Objects
Setting Up Alarming
You can set up four types of alarm scenarios for an analog input:
• Off Alarm Limits. The analog input causes an alarm based on the Off
Alarm Limits you enter. This is the default setting.
• On Alarm Limits. The analog input causes an alarm based on the On
Alarm Limits you enter.
• Referencer control of On or Off Alarm Limits. A referencer controls
the use of on or off limits.
• Disabled for no alarming.
The present value of an analog input is either inside or outside a range of
normal values that you define. If the present value is outside the range of
normal values, the analog input is either in a warning or alarm state. To
direct the system to ignore a warning or alarm state, disable the alarm.
The alarming limit setup can be based on a binary property status. For
example, you may want to allow a static pressure sensor input to alarm
only when the associated fan is running. In this case, you would set up
the fan status as the referencer for on/off alarm limits and set limits for
on and off conditions appropriately.
To prevent nuisance alarms on start up of equipment, use the On Delay
for Referencer field to set up a delay time before issuing an alarm on a
change in status from off to on.
To set up an alarm:
1. Click the Alarming tab from the Analog Input editor to display the
Alarming screen (see Figure 203).
2. Click Enable Alarming to make the rest of the fields on the screen
available for editing.
236 BMTX-SVP01A-EN
Creating an Analog Input
3. Select On or Off from the On or Off Alarm Limits list, or select a prop-
erty reference (for detailed information on referencing a property, see
Chapter 4, “Using Referencer Edit Controls”).
4. If you selected On or Off Alarm Limits:
On Alarm Limits: Enter High Alarm, Low Alarm, High Warning,
Low Warning values in the On Alarm Limits Setup fields.
Off Alarm Limits: Enter High Alarm and Low Alarm values in the
Off Alarm Limits Setup fields.
5. If you referenced a property, enter values in these fields:
• High Alarm and Low Alarm (off limits)
• High Alarm and Low Alarm, High Warning and Low Warning (on
limits)
• On Delay for Referencer
6. Enter a Return to Normal Deadband value.
7. Enter a Minimum Time in Alarm Before Notification value.
8. Select a CPL Program to run from the program list (optional).
Note:
A CPL routine is called by an entry into alarm and a return out
of alarm.
BMTX-SVP01A-EN 237
Creating Input/Output Objects
238 BMTX-SVP01A-EN
Creating a Binary Input
3. Click New. The New Binary Input Name dialog box displays (see
Figure 206).
4. Enter a name for the input. Make the name as informative as possi-
ble. Use a maximum of 32 characters.
5. Click OK to display the Binary Input editor (see Figure 207 on page
240).
BMTX-SVP01A-EN 239
Creating Input/Output Objects
6. Click the Setup tab to display the Setup screen (see Figure 208).
240 BMTX-SVP01A-EN
Creating a Binary Input
Setting Up Alarming
You can set up three types of alarm scenarios for a binary input:
• Alarming always enabled
• Enable/disable via referencer
• Feedback referencing
Binary inputs have two states. They can either be active (on) or inactive
(off). You define which of these states is the alarm state. You can also
choose to disable the alarm state. If you only want to process alarms
under certain conditions, select a binary referencer to determine whether
alarms are enabled or disabled.
If you want alarm processing to occur and the normal state of the binary
input can change dynamically (sometimes active is normal, sometimes
inactive is normal), specify a feedback reference to determine if the
binary input is in alarm. A feedback reference is a binary property in the
system that mirrors the state of the referenced property of the binary
input. If the present value of the binary input and the current value of the
feedback reference do not match, the binary input is in alarm.
For example, choose the binary output command for fan start/stop as a
feedback referencer for the fan status. If the two states do not match, an
alarm is generated.
To set up an alarm:
1. Click the Alarming tab from the Binary Input editor to display the
Alarming screen (see Figure 209 on page 242).
BMTX-SVP01A-EN 241
Creating Input/Output Objects
2. Click Enable Alarming to make the rest of the fields on the screen
available for editing.
3. Select Alarming Always Enabled, Enable/Disable Follows Referencer,
or Feedback Referencing.
• If you selected Alarming Always Enabled, select On or Off in the
Input Alarm State.
• If you selected Enable/Disable Follows Referencer or Feedback
Referencing, select a property reference. For detailed information
on referencing a property, see Chapter 4, “Using Referencer Edit
Controls”.
• If you selected Enable/Disable Follows Referencer, enter the num-
ber of minutes to delay in the Delay for Enable/Disable Refer-
encer field.
4. Enter a Minimum Time in Alarm Before Notification value.
5. Select a CPL Program to run from the program list (optional).
Note:
A CPL routine runs whenever the state changes. The routing
must determine the state in order to provide the necessary con-
trol.
242 BMTX-SVP01A-EN
Creating a Binary Input
BMTX-SVP01A-EN 243
Creating Input/Output Objects
3. Click New. The New Analog Output Name dialog box displays (see
Figure 212).
4. Enter a name for the output. Make the name as informative as possi-
ble. Use a maximum of 32 characters.
244 BMTX-SVP01A-EN
Creating an Analog Output
6. Click the Setup tab to display the Setup screen (see Figure 214).
BMTX-SVP01A-EN 245
Creating Input/Output Objects
11. Click Save. If you use a referencer, the analog output is automatically
saved to the BCU where the referencer resides. If not, the Save dialog
box displays. Click the name of a BCU to save the output to.
After saving the analog output, you can save global references (see
“Setting Up Global References for Analog or Binary Outputs” on
page 250).
12. Continue using the editor to enter overrides, to enter a control class,
or to set security classes, if desired (see the section “Entering a Con-
trol Class” on page 246).
246 BMTX-SVP01A-EN
Creating a Binary Output
3. Click New to display the New Binary Output Name dialog box (see
Figure 217).
4. Enter a name for the output. Make the name as informative as possi-
ble. Use a maximum of 32 characters.
5. Click OK to display the Binary Output editor (see Figure 218 on page
248).
BMTX-SVP01A-EN 247
Creating Input/Output Objects
6. Click the Setup tab to display the Setup screen (see Figure 219).
248 BMTX-SVP01A-EN
Creating a Binary Output
• Minimum On Time
• Minimum Off Time
13. Click Save. If you used a referencer, the binary output is automati-
cally saved to the BCU where the referencer resides. If not, the Save
dialog box displays. Click on the name of a BCU to save the output to.
After saving the binary output, you can save global references (see
“Setting Up Global References for Analog or Binary Outputs” on
page 250).
14. Continue using the editor to enter overrides, to enter a control class,
or to set security classes, if desired (see the section “Entering a Con-
trol Class” on page 249).
BMTX-SVP01A-EN 249
Creating Input/Output Objects
Note:
The Global Referencers button is not available until the analog
or binary output has been saved (click the Save button).
250 BMTX-SVP01A-EN
Setting Up Global References for Analog or Binary Outputs
3. In the Object Type field, select the type of object. Select only one
object type.
4. In the Property field, select the property you want this object to con-
trol.
5. In the Available Names field, select the name(s) of specific object(s).
6. Click Save Selections. The Global References dialog box closes and
the Setup screen displays.
Note:
Once a global reference has been set up it can not be deleted from this edi-
tor. In order to delete the reference you must go the the editor for each
object that has been referenced to this point.
BMTX-SVP01A-EN 251
Creating Input/Output Objects
Modifying an Input/Output
You can modify any parameter of an input or output at any time.
To modify an input/output:
1. From the Setup menu, select Inputs/Outputs. The list of inputs and
outputs displays.
2. Select the type of input or output you wish to modify. The Select Input
dialog box (specific to the item you chose) displays.
3. Click the name of the input or output you want to modify.
4. Click OK. The editor for the selected input or output displays.
5. Click the appropriate tab at the top of the editor to display the screen
that you want to modify.
Note:
Be careful when changing the name of an input or output. A
name change will affect any CPL routine that uses the input or
output. (See Chapter 24, “Custom Programming Language”.)
252 BMTX-SVP01A-EN
Overriding an Analog or Binary Output
Note:
Priority control ranges from 1 (highest) to 16 (lowest). The com-
mand with the highest priority controls the object. To take con-
trol off, you must select the Release Control button at the
Override dialog box. Then the next highest priority commands
the object.
2. Click Override to display the Override dialog box (see Figure 224 on
page 254).
BMTX-SVP01A-EN 253
Creating Input/Output Objects
254 BMTX-SVP01A-EN
Overriding an Analog or Binary Output
Note:
The Priority Array list shows all the applications and priorities
that are currently commanding the object. The Present Value
field shows what the object is controlled to, when it was con-
trolled last, and what application or user is controlling it.
BMTX-SVP01A-EN 255
Creating Input/Output Objects
256 BMTX-SVP01A-EN
Deleting an Input/Output
3. Click on the Access field next to each class to allow or deny access. A
check in the field allows access. No check denies access.
4. Click OK to display the Classes screen.
Deleting an Input/Output
To delete an input or output, use the Delete Object utility in the Tools
menu (see Chapter 37, “Deleting Objects and Sites”).
BMTX-SVP01A-EN 257
Creating Input/Output Objects
258 BMTX-SVP01A-EN
Chapter 17
This chapter describes input and output options available for the model
BMTX and the model BMTW BCUs.
referenced property
BMTX-SVP01A-EN 259
BCU Inputs and Outputs
Each of the two binary inputs has four properties with different functions:
• Binary Input [01] —Timed override (TOV). You can use this property
as a TOV trigger for the TOV Application or a TOV CPL routine. This
property is on if the Binary Input has been closed at any time in the
last two minutes.
• Binary Input [02]—Fail. You can use this property to monitor status
for alarms. This property is on if the Binary Input has not been closed
at any time the last two minutes.
• Binary Input [03]—Latch. This property will be on if the Binary Input
has been closed any time in the last two minutes. You can monitor
momentary inputs with this property.
• Binary Input [04]—Status. This property shows the current state of
the Binary input point. The input must remain continuously on or off
for at least two seconds before the property will change.
referenced property
260 BMTX-SVP01A-EN
BMTW I/O Module
• Analog Input [02]—Pulse count since last read. Note that each time
you read this property from the Tracer Summit Workstation the BCU
resets it to zero.
• Analog Input [03]—Pulse Total. This is the number of pulses since the
last power reset on the BMTX. This property has a maximum value of
999,999,999, if it exceeds this number it reverts to 0.
• Analog Iput [04]—Not Used. This property has a value of 0.
BMTX-SVP01A-EN 261
BCU Inputs and Outputs
Note:
The BCU I/O module buttons are only selectable for standard
and high capacity BCUs.
1. From the Setup menu, select Site Configuration (see Chapter 6, “Con-
figuring Tracer Summit BCU Sites”).
2. From the Site Configuration editor, click the Devices tab to display
the Devices screen (see Figure 230):
• If the appropriate BCU is listed, select it. Then click the Edit
Device button. The Edit Device dialog box displays (see
Figure 231 on page 263).
• If the appropriate BCU is not listed, click the Create Device but-
ton. The Create New Device dialog box displays (see “Configuring
Tracer Summit BCU Sites” on page 33).
262 BMTX-SVP01A-EN
Creating the BCU I/O Module Object
3. Click the BCU I/O module Add button to display the Create New BCU
I/O module dialog box (see Figure 232).
4. In the Name field, enter a name for the BCU I/O module. Use a maxi-
mum of 32 characters.
You must enter a name before you can save the new BCU I/O module
object. You can modify the name at any time from the Edit BCU I/O
module dialog box. You can access the dialog box from the BCU I/O
module Edit button. Click OK to return to the main screen.
5. To define security access, click the Security Classes button to display
the Security Classes dialog box (see “Setting Security Access for the
BCU I/O Module” on page 268).
6. Click OK to return to the dialog box.
BMTX-SVP01A-EN 263
BCU Inputs and Outputs
264 BMTX-SVP01A-EN
Setting Up Universal Inputs
1. From the BCU I/O Module editor, click the Setup tab to display the
Setup tab screen (see Figure 234).
2. Configure the input Type fields (1-5) to match the BCU I/O module
board UIP jumper settings.
If the device is a pulse meter, enter the correction factor in the Pulse
Multiplier field (see “Calculating the Pulse Multiplier” on page 266).
This field is unavailable for other input types.
If the device is an analog type (voltage, current, or thermistor), the
Disable Analog Failure check box is available:
• Check this box to disable the alarm within 2% of the range end
points.
• Leave this box unchecked to alarm on endpoint conditions.
Note:
Verify input type settings with the BCU I/O module UIP jump-
ers.
3. See “Setting Up System Objects” on page 266 for creating and setting
up system objects to reference the inputs.
BMTX-SVP01A-EN 265
BCU Inputs and Outputs
Note:
The AIP and BIP objects must be saved in the same BCU as the
BCU I/O module object.
266 BMTX-SVP01A-EN
Setting Up System Objects
BMTX-SVP01A-EN 267
BCU Inputs and Outputs
3. To set security access for this object and define class access, click the
Security Classes button to display the Change Security Classes dialog
box (See Figure 236).
268 BMTX-SVP01A-EN
Setting Up System Objects
4. Click on the Access field next to each class to grant or deny access. A
check in the field grants access. No check denies access.
5. Click OK to display the Classes screen.
BMTX-SVP01A-EN 269
BCU Inputs and Outputs
270 BMTX-SVP01A-EN
Chapter 18
BMTX-SVP01A-EN 271
Chiller Plant Control
272 BMTX-SVP01A-EN
Creating a New Chiller Plant
Note:
The settings described for the Chiller Plant editor screens are
required entries. (For more information, refer to Tracer Summit
online help.) Verify that default entries on all screens of the edi-
tor are correct for the chiller plant.
3. Enter the name of the Chiller Plant. Make the name as informative
as possible. Use a maximum of 32 characters. You must enter a name
before you can save the new chiller plant. You can modify the name at
any time from the System screen of the Chiller Plant editor.
4. Click OK. The Chiller Plant editor displays.
BMTX-SVP01A-EN 273
Chiller Plant Control
274 BMTX-SVP01A-EN
Modifying Startup Settings
BMTX-SVP01A-EN 275
Chiller Plant Control
2. Make a selection:
• To use the temperature-based subtract method, verify that the
Design Delta Temperature is correct for the Chiller Plant (the
system default is 10.0ºF).
• To use the flow-based subtract method, click Flow (see
Figure 243). Then use the Bypass Pipe Flow referencer edit con-
trol to reference the property for the Bypass Pipe Flow.
276 BMTX-SVP01A-EN
Adding Chiller Objects to the Chiller Plant
2. In the Chiller Type list box, select the type of chiller to be added.
3. In the Chiller Name list, select the chiller name to be added.
4. Click Add to add the chiller object to the Chiller Plant Control mem-
ber’s list. The Add Chiller dialog box displays (see Figure 245).
BMTX-SVP01A-EN 277
Chiller Plant Control
5. In the Index field, select the array index used to display individual
chillers. Use the default index number for the Chiller object.
6. In the Sequence Type field, select the chiller sequence type: Normal,
Base, Peak, or Swing.
Normal chillers rotate in a round-robin fashion (the last on is the first
off). A base chiller is always the first chiller on and the last chiller off.
A peak chiller is always the last chiller to run and the first chiller off.
A swing chiller is the first on and then alternates after that (see Table
6 on page 278 for an example of how a system having chillers of each
type are stepped on and off).
Note:
The PC Workstation validates these settings to eliminate dupli-
cate types for base, peak, or swing. One of each may be defined.
After a base, peak or swing chiller has been chosen, it is
removed from the drop-down list of member choices. There is no
limit to the number of normal chillers allowed.
278 BMTX-SVP01A-EN
Setting Up Individual Chiller Objects
2. In the member’s list, click the Index number of the chiller you want to
set up.
3. Click the Chiller Setup button to display the Chiller Setup dialog box
(see Figure 247).
Figure 247. Chiller Setup Dialog Box
BMTX-SVP01A-EN 279
Chiller Plant Control
Note:
Be sure all chillers in this Chiller Plant use the same units for
capacity (for example, tons, KWH, etc.), or flow (for example,
gpm, l/s, etc.).
280 BMTX-SVP01A-EN
Routing Alarms and Events and Setting Security Access
BMTX-SVP01A-EN 281
Chiller Plant Control
3. Click on the Access field next to each class to grant or deny access to
the security class. A check in the field grants access. If unchecked,
permission to the security class is denied.
4. Click OK to close the Change Security Classes dialog box.
282 BMTX-SVP01A-EN
Chapter 19
BMTX-SVP01A-EN 283
Area Control Application
284 BMTX-SVP01A-EN
Using Area Control
Cool 1 Off 1 On 3
Heat Off Off Off Off 3 Unoc- Unoc- Unoc- Unoc- 3,5
Unoccupy
cupy cupy cupy cupy
Cool Off Off Off Off 3
BMTX-SVP01A-EN 285
Area Control Application
286 BMTX-SVP01A-EN
Creating an Area
Creating an Area
To create an area, you perform these tasks:
• Open and name the area (as described in this section)
• Assign members to the area (see “Assigning Members” on page 288)
• Define referencers for the indoor and outdoor air temperature sensor
fields (see “Setting Air Temperature Sensors” on page 290)
• Define parameters for night economizing (see “Setting Up Timed
Override” on page 293)
• Establish heating and cooling setpoints for the occupied and unoccu-
pied modes and occupied and unoccupied differentials (see “Setting
Setpoints and Differentials” on page 291)
• Assign event classes (see “Assigning Event Classes” on page 295)
• Define security access (see “Setting Security Access for the Area” on
page 296)
• If necessary, enable and set duration for timed override members (see
“Setting Up Timed Override” on page 293).
After you create an area, you should assign the Area object to a time of
day schedule (see Chapter 23, “Time of Day Scheduling”). In the time of
day schedule, you must include a night economizing value and a lighting
value in addition to the present value if you intend to use those functions
in area control.
To create an area:
1. From the Setup menu, select Area. The Select Area dialog box dis-
plays (see Figure 252).
2. Click New. The New Area Name dialog box displays (see Figure 253
on page 288).
BMTX-SVP01A-EN 287
Area Control Application
3. Enter a name in the Area Name field. Make the name as informative
as possible. Use a maximum of 32 characters. You must enter a name
before you can save the new area. You can modify the name at any
time from the Setup screen of the Area Control editor.
4. Click OK. The Area Control editor displays.
5. Click Save. The first time you save a new area, the Save Area dialog
box displays (see Figure 254).
6. Click the name of the BCU in which you want the area to reside.
7. Click OK.
Assigning Members
1. From the Area Control editor, click the Members tab (see Figure 255).
288 BMTX-SVP01A-EN
Assigning Members
Note:
You can assign a member to only one area. If you try to add a
member that is already assigned to another area, a message
indicates that the member is currently assigned to another
area. Do not assign a member to an area that also is an AHU or
vent only member of a VAV Air System.
5. Click on the arrow to select the member type from the list in the
Member Type field. Member types include Heating, Cooling, Heating/
Cooling, Lighting, and Ventilation.
6. Click the Night Economize check box if you want to use this member
for night economizing. The only member types that you can check for
night economizing are Cooling Only and Heating/Cooling.
7. Click the Timed Override (TOV) initiator checkbox to allow timed
override requests to be initiated from Trane SCC (except for very
early versions of the ZN510/511), VAV and Voyager members. Timed
override requests for these members can be generated from a Trane
zone sensor, a Tracer Summit PC Workstation, or a BCU operator dis-
play.
Note:
The Enable Timed Override checkbox on the Setup tab also has
to be checked in order for the area to process requests and can-
cels from TOV members (see “Setting Up Timed Override” on
page 293).
8. Click OK to add the member to the Area Members list (see Figure 257
on page 290).
BMTX-SVP01A-EN 289
Area Control Application
Note:
The Heat/Cool Input field should generally be set to Auto. For
details, see Tracer Summit online help.
290 BMTX-SVP01A-EN
Setting Setpoints and Differentials
BMTX-SVP01A-EN 291
Area Control Application
292 BMTX-SVP01A-EN
Setting Up Timed Override
Note:
You can edit this field when timed override is active, but the
change will not take effect until the next timed override start
request.
BMTX-SVP01A-EN 293
Area Control Application
5. Click Save.
Note:
Area members in the member list on the Members tab must be
set up for timed override in order for the area to process
requests and cancels from TOV members (see, “Assigning Mem-
bers” on page 288).
294 BMTX-SVP01A-EN
Assigning Event Classes
Note:
In the Site Configuration editor, you can choose which event
receiver (workstation, pager, BCU event log, etc.) gets messages
from an event class. For more information on choosing an event
receiver, see “Setting Up Event Routing” on page 82.
BMTX-SVP01A-EN 295
Area Control Application
3. Click on the Access field next to each class to grant or deny access. A
check in the field grants access. No check denies access.
4. Click OK to display the Classes screen.
296 BMTX-SVP01A-EN
Overriding an Area
Overriding an Area
The Override function enables you to manually override the present value
and lighting value of an area. It also allows you to make a timed override
request if timed override is enabled for the area.
2. Click Override. The Override dialog box displays (see Figure 265).
BMTX-SVP01A-EN 297
Area Control Application
298 BMTX-SVP01A-EN
Deleting an Area
Note:
You can also get to this dialog box by clicking on the TOV but-
ton on the toolbar.
Deleting an Area
An area cannot be deleted from the Area Control editor. Use the Delete
Object function from the Tools menu to delete an Area object (see Chapter
37, “Deleting Objects and Sites”).
BMTX-SVP01A-EN 299
Area Control Application
300 BMTX-SVP01A-EN
Chapter 20
The Tracer Summit Comm5 VAV air system (VAS) coordinates a collec-
tion of variable-air-volume (VAV) boxes and an air-handling unit (AHU)
to create a coherent air system. VAS Comm5 provides the following
capabilities:
• Manages common space VAVs to prevent over-pressurization of the
ductwork.
• Controls the AHU to provide air when any VAV member is in the
occupied mode.
• Provides built-in ventilation and pressure optimization features.
• Provides air and water balancing features.
• Automates the commissioning and calibration of VAVs.
• Reports status information on a standard graphic, a standard report,
and the VAS Comm5 editor.
VAS Comm5 supports the following controllers:
• Tracer VV550/551 VAV controllers (recommended) and other control-
lers that support the VAV object of the LonMark® Space Comfort Con-
troller (SCC) profile
• Tracer AH540/541 and MP580/581 controllers and other controllers
that support the LonMark® Discharge Air Controller (DAC) profile
To create a VAV air system for Comm3 and Comm4 controllers, refer to
Chapter 21, “Comm3/Comm4 VAV Air Systems.”
Note:
The optimization features work only with Tracer VV550/551
controllers. If you use other controllers, additional features of
VAS Comm5 may not be available depending on how the con-
trollers implement the SCC profile.
BMTX-SVP01A-EN 301
Comm5 VAV Air Systems
2. Select an existing VAS object and click OK. The VAS Comm5 editor
displays (see Figure 268).
302 BMTX-SVP01A-EN
Creating a Comm5 VAV Air System
Figure 269. New VAV Air Systems (VAS Comm5) Name Dialog Box
3. Type a name in the VAV Air Systems (VAS Comm5) Name field. Make
the name as informative as possible. Use a maximum of 32 charac-
ters. You can modify the name at any time from the Setup screen of
the VAV Air System editor.
4. Click OK. The Status screen of the VAS Comm5 editor displays.
5. You will not be able to save the VAS until you add at least one VAV
member (see “Assigning VAS Members” on page 304). After you have
done so, click Save. The first time you save a new area, the Save VAV
Air System dialog box displays (see Figure 270 on page 304).
BMTX-SVP01A-EN 303
Comm5 VAV Air Systems
Figure 270. Save VAV Air Systems (VAS Comm5) Dialog Box
6. Select the name of the BCU in which you want the VAV Air System to
reside.
7. Click OK.
Note:
To delete a VAS object, use the Delete Objects utility from the
Tools menu. Refer to Chapter 37, “Deleting Objects and Sites.”
Note:
VAS Comm5 supports two types of air-handler objects: Tracer
MP580/581 objects and DAC objects. The air-handler controller
must be configured as a DAC device.
To assign members:
1. From the VAS Comm5 editor, click the Members tab (see Figure 271
on page 305).
304 BMTX-SVP01A-EN
Creating a Comm5 VAV Air System
2. To add VAV Members, click the Add Members button in the VAV
Members area. The VAV Members dialog box displays (see
Figure 272).
BMTX-SVP01A-EN 305
Comm5 VAV Air Systems
3. Select the VAVs you want to add to the VAS. To add more than one
VAV, hold down the Ctrl key and click each VAV you want to add.
All available Space Comfort Controllers (SCCs) display in the avail-
able VAVs list. Make sure that you select only SCCs configured as
VAVs (VAS Comm5 does not check this for you).
4. Click the Add button. The VAVs you want to add display in the
Selected VAVs list.
5. When you are done adding VAV Members, click OK.
6. To add the AHU member, click the Add Member button in the AHU
Member area. The AHU Member dialog box displays (see Figure 273).
7. In the Type list, select the type of air handler you want to add to the
VAS.
8. In the Name list, select the air handler you want to add to the VAS.
9. Click OK.
306 BMTX-SVP01A-EN
Creating a Comm5 VAV Air System
• You cannot schedule common space VAVs because only the VAS can
control them. Common space VAVs still provide space temperature
control of the zone like any other VAV.
• If you decide to change a common space VAV back to a normal VAV,
you will have to manually release the priority level 9 control that VAS
has over the VAV. If you do not release the priority control, Area will
not be able control the VAV because it controls at a lower priority
level.
To assign common space VAVs:
1. In the VAV Members table on the Members screen, select the Com-
mon Space check boxes for the VAV members that you want to serve
as common space VAVs (see Figure 274).
2. Click Save to save your changes.
BMTX-SVP01A-EN 307
Comm5 VAV Air Systems
2. In the AHU Startup Delay field, type the number of minutes for the
VAS to wait before starting the AHU.
The AHU startup delay should be at least the amount of time it takes
for the air valves in the common space VAVs to open to an acceptable
position. The startup delay prevents the ductwork from over-
pressurizing.
3. In the Common Space VAV Shutdown Delay field, type the number of
minutes for the VAS to wait before shutting down common space
VAVs after the AHU enters the unoccupied mode.
The shutdown delay should be at least the amount of time it takes the
AHU to go from full speed to a complete stop. To prevent the duct-
work from over-pressurizing, VAS Comm5 prevents its common space
VAVs from entering the unoccupied mode during the shutdown delay.
Note that Tracer VV550/551 controllers have an automatic three-
308 BMTX-SVP01A-EN
Setting up a Comm5 VAV Air System
minute shutdown delay, which begins after the VAS shutdown delay
is over.
4. In the VAV Calibration field, select Recalibrate if you want to initiate
a recalibration of VAV members. You can also set up a referencer to a
binary output to trigger recalibration (for example, you can reference
a binary output and assign a schedule to the output). The BCU stag-
gers the calibration requests to prevent the ductwork from over-pres-
surizing.
Because Tracer VV550/551 calibrate automatically when they transi-
tion from occupied to unoccupied, use the VAV Calibration field only
for VAVs that are continually occupied.
5. Select the Allow VAV Aux Heat at Night check box to allow VAV aux-
iliary heat at night.
If you want to disable auxiliary heat at night to reduce energy usage,
clear this check box. For this feature to work, you must also reference
the Auxiliary Heat Control property of all VAV members to the VAS
Aux Heat Control Request property (you can do this globally by click-
ing the Set VAV References button on the Members screen as
described in “Setting up Global References” on page 310).
6. Select the Enable Duct Pressure Optimization check box if you want
to use duct pressure optimization. Type new setpoints if necessary. In
most cases, use the default settings for best performance. (Press F1
for a description of each field.)
The duct pressure optimization feature determines the optimal duct
pressure based on VAV air-valve positions. This optimization reduces
energy costs by ensuring that the AHU is working just hard enough
to satisfy the most-open VAV air valve. Duct pressure optimization
works only with Tracer VV550/551 controllers.
7. Select the Enable Ventilation Optimization check box if you want to
use ventilation optimization. Type new setpoints or set up referencers
if necessary. In most cases, use the default setpoints for best perfor-
mance. (Press F1 for a description of each field.)
The ventilation optimization feature manages the outdoor air intake
system to meet ANSI/ASHRAE Standard 62-2001: Ventilation for
Acceptable Indoor Air Quality. This standard specifies minimum ven-
tilation rates and indoor air quality to minimize the potential for
adverse health effects for occupants. Ventilation optimization works
only with Tracer VV550/551 controllers.
8. Click Save to save your changes.
BMTX-SVP01A-EN 309
Comm5 VAV Air Systems
310 BMTX-SVP01A-EN
Setting Security Access
3. Select the Access check box next to each class to grant or deny access
to the security class. A check in the field grants access.
4. Click OK to close the Change Security Classes dialog box.
5. Click the Save button to save your changes.
BMTX-SVP01A-EN 311
Comm5 VAV Air Systems
To perform an override:
1. Select the appropriate option.
2. Click the Apply button to perform a system-wide override.
Note:
Use the Rover Air and Water Balancing tool if you need addi-
tional balancing features.
312 BMTX-SVP01A-EN
Balancing Air and Water Flow
To Release an override:
◆ Click the Release Override Option to release the system-wide over-
ride.
Note:
If you do not release overrides from the VAS Comm5 editor,
they will release automatically in each VAV controller after a
certain period of time (by default, overrides to Tracer VV550/
551 controllers release automatically after 10 hours, though
this time can be changed in Rover Comm5).
BMTX-SVP01A-EN 313
Comm5 VAV Air Systems
Autocommissioning VAVs
Autocommissioning is a special operating sequence that validates the
proper operation of all inputs and outputs of VAV members. Because air
valves are closed during parts of the autocommissioning test, the BCU
commissions the VAVs in several groups to avoid over-pressurization. The
BCU divides common space VAVs evenly among the groups.
Note:
Because the BCU staggers the VAVs being autocommissioned,
starting another staggered sequence will interrupt the current
sequence. For example, if a calibration sequence is initiated
while autocommissioning is in progress, autocommissioning
will stop and calibration will begin. Autocommissioning will not
resume after the calibration sequence finishes.
To autocommission VAVs:
1. From the VAS Comm5 editor, click the Setup tab.
2. If duct pressure optimization is enabled, clear the Enable Duct Pres-
sure Optimization check box, then click Save.
3. Click the Overrides tab.
4. In the VAV Autocommissioning Sequence area, select Start, then click
the Apply button.
5. Click OK to acknowledge the message that displays.
6. To check the progress of the autocommissioning sequence, open the
VAS graphic by double-clicking the VAS icon in the navigation tree.
While autocommissioning is in effect, the Mode: Active property of
each VAV member will report Test (see Figure 279). Autocommission-
ing should take no more than 90 minutes, regardless of the size of
your VAS.
314 BMTX-SVP01A-EN
Chapter 21
The variable air volume air system (VAS), usually referred to as the VAV
air system, is made up of variable air volume (VAV) boxes, the air-han-
dling equipment that supplies hot and cold air to those boxes, and ventila-
tion-only members. VAS works with Area Control and Time of Day
Scheduling to manage the air handling unit and the associated VAV
boxes.
Using the VAV air system, you can:
• Determine the heating or cooling control action of its VAV members
• Audit VAV member requests for Night Heat/Cool and Night Econo-
mize to verify that adequate demand exists before enabling the air
handler
• Total the minimum cooling flow setpoints and present value votes of
its VAV members to determine its own and the air handler’s present
value
• Control AHU startup and VAV shutdown delays during occupancy
transitions
• Provide an offset control value for VAV I members
Depending on the member characteristics, you can use these options:
• Drive VAV boxes to maximum airflow position when the VAS heat/
cool mode is heating
• Provide VAV airflow overrides for all VAV members
• Specify supply air setpoints for air handler reference
These tasks are all accomplished through the VAV Air System editor,
which is one of several editors in Tracer Summit that you use to set up,
define, and modify elements in the system.
To create a VAV air system for Comm5 controllers, refer to Chapter 20,
“Comm5 VAV Air Systems.”
BMTX-SVP01A-EN 315
Comm3/Comm4 VAV Air Systems
2. Select an existing VAS object and click OK. The VAV Air System edi-
tor displays (see Figure 281).
316 BMTX-SVP01A-EN
Creating a VAV Air System Object
3. Enter a name in the VAV Air System Name field. Make the name as
informative as possible. Use a maximum of 32 characters. You must
enter a name before you can save the new VAV Air System object. You
can modify the name at any time from the Setup screen of the VAV
Air System editor.
4. Click OK. The Status screen of the VAV Air System editor displays.
5. Click Save. The first time you save a new area, the Save VAV Air Sys-
tem dialog box displays (see Figure 283).
BMTX-SVP01A-EN 317
Comm3/Comm4 VAV Air Systems
6. Select the name of the BCU in which you want the VAV Air System to
reside.
7. Click OK.
2. From the Category list box, select the category of the VAS members
you would like to add. There are three options:
• Air handler
• VAV
• Vent only
3. In the Type list box, select the type of Air Handler, VAV, or Vent Only
object from these options:
• Air handler: Binary Output, CPL Program, CSC, DAC, Intellipak,
PCM, TCM, UPCM, Voyager, Voyager (Comm3), MP580/581
318 BMTX-SVP01A-EN
Assigning VAS Members
Note:
The BCU must be online in order for the reset to work. How-
ever, the Reset Votes button is always enabled.
Example:
The site called STARPORT has two VAV Air Systems in it (VAS#1 and
VAS#2). Originally, each air system was set up with 20 VAV members
each, which is a mistake. VAS#1 really has 18 VAVs connected to it while
VAS#2 has 22 VAVs connected to it. To correct the situation, you must
first remove the two extra VAVs from VAS#1. Then after saving the
changes to VAS#1, you must click the Reset Votes button. The two extra
VAVs are then added to VAS#2. Changes to VAS#2 are saved.
Note:
It is not necessary to reset votes when VAVs are added to a
VAS, only when VAVs are removed.
BMTX-SVP01A-EN 319
Comm3/Comm4 VAV Air Systems
2. To modify the VAS name, enter a new name in the VAS Name field.
3. To modify the VAS minimum flow value, enter the minimum amount
of air that the air handler members can deliver when the supply fan
is on in the VAS Minimum Flow field. You can obtain this number
from the air handler manufacturer.
4. To modify the heat/cool input, select one of these choices in the
required Heat/Cool Input field:
• To allow the VAS to automatically determine its own heat/cool
mode, select MWU Settings (morning warm up) from the list box.
The heat/cool mode of the VAS will change between heating and
cooling based on the values of the VAS morning warm up sensor,
setpoint, and differential.
• If the air handler is a heating only or a cooling only machine,
select either Heating or Cooling from the list box. Do not use a
referencer.
320 BMTX-SVP01A-EN
Setting Up a VAV Air System
Note:
Only VAV II/III/IV members can use the VAS supply air tem-
perature. VAV I members do not use the VAS supply air tem-
perature even if a sensor is assigned to the entry field. VAV I
control action follows the heat/cool mode of the VAS.
Note:
During an Airflow Drive Max override, parallel fans, electric
heat, and hot water heat are disabled for VAVs that have them.
The VAV Airflow Drive Max field appears twice in the editor;
once on the Setup screen and once on the Overrides screen.
• If you select Auto, the UCM uses its local control algorithms to
decide when to implement the Drive max function.
• If you use a referencer edit control, Auto displays in the entry
field when the referencer is in the zero (0) state. In the zero state,
the UCM can still locally decide to drive to maximum flow if it
needs to. When the referencer is in the one (1) state, Drive Max
appears in the entry field, and the Drive Max override is initiated
from the Tracer Summit system.
• Some air handler units (such as IntelliPak, Voyager, and CSC)
have properties that indicate when they are going into a constant
volume heating mode, and thus require that all downstream VAV
boxes open their air valves to maximum position. You must assign
the property from the Air Handling Unit as the referencer. For the
IntelliPak and Voyager, this property is called VAS Drive to Max.
• If your air handler does not have a predefined property for heat-
ing mode, click the Overrides tab. On the Overrides screen, check
BMTX-SVP01A-EN 321
Comm3/Comm4 VAV Air Systems
the box for Drive VAVs to Max Flow if VAS is Heating. Click Save
and return to the Setup screen.
Note:
If you selected MWU Settings in the Heat/Cool input field, the
system uses the Morning Warmup fields to determine its heat/
cool mode. (These fields have no other bearing on control.)
322 BMTX-SVP01A-EN
Modifying Setpoints
Modifying Setpoints
The default values for the fields found on the VAV Air System editor’s Set-
points screen are what you would expect to find on most job sites. Occa-
sionally, however, you may need to change supply air setpoints,
changeover delay times, changeover votes, and the VAV I control offset.
To change setpoints:
1. From the Setup menu, select VAV Air System to display the Select
VAS dialog box. The dialog box lists all existing VAS objects.
2. From the list displayed in the Select VAS dialog box, select the one
you want to modify.
3. Click OK to display the VAV Air System editor. The Status window
becomes active and displays the settings and status of the object you
selected.
4. Click the Setpoints tab to display the Setpoints screen (see
Figure 286).
BMTX-SVP01A-EN 323
Comm3/Comm4 VAV Air Systems
Modifying Overrides
The Overrides screen of the VAV Air System editor contains the fields
that override normal VAV box operation. To override the VAV terminal
units’ flow control you can assign a binary reference to the appropriate
flow override. You can also select the desired flow override from the list
box.
You can override the VAV unit flow control either from the VAV object edi-
tor (individually) or from the VAS to which the VAV unit belongs. The
VAV object editor source is the higher priority if there are overrides from
both sources.
To modify overrides:
1. Click the Overrides tab in the VAS editor to display the Overrides
screen (see Figure 287).
324 BMTX-SVP01A-EN
Routing Alarms and Events and Setting Security Access
2. In the Control Class field, select a control class. The control class
defines the event class that will receive an event message when the
present value of the VAV Air System changes.
BMTX-SVP01A-EN 325
Comm3/Comm4 VAV Air Systems
3. Click on the Access field next to each class to grant or deny access to
the security class. A check in the field grants access. If unchecked,
permission to the security class is denied.
4. Click OK to close the Change Security Classes dialog box.
326 BMTX-SVP01A-EN
Chapter 22
Note:
When in the unoccupied mode, the HPLC application monitors
the need for heating or cooling (represented by the terminal
load property) of all WSHP members in order to determine
when to go into the Night Heat/Cool mode. Each WSHP mem-
ber votes its need-to-run based on a terminal load that is
greater than 30% (a positive 30% for cooling and a negative
30% for heating). When enough WSHP members vote a need-to-
run, the HPLC application transitions from the unoccupied
mode to the Night Heat/Cool mode, enabling the Tracer loop
controller to run.
All WSHP members vote continually to the HPLC concerning
whether they have a need-to-run or not. The Need-to-Run
Threshold located on the Setup screen determines how many
WSHPs are needed to initiate Night Heat/Cool operation. In the
Night Heat/Cool mode, the HPLC application commands the
Tracer loop controller to run. In turn, the Tracer loop controller
monitors system water flow and enables the WSHP compres-
sors to run, allowing the units to reach their unoccupied set-
points. The HPLC transitions back to the unoccupied mode
when enough WSHP members fall within their unoccupied set-
points.
BMTX-SVP01A-EN 327
Heat Pump Loop Control
328 BMTX-SVP01A-EN
Creating a New Heat Pump Loop Object
From the Status screen you can view the following occupancy status of
WSHP members:
• Tracer loop controller mode (as determined by the HPLC application)
• Current total heating and cooling loads for all WSHPs on this loop
• Compressor enable mode (as determined from the referencer on the
Setup screen)
• Need-to-Run Votes
3. Type the name of the heat pump loop. Make the name as informative
as possible. Use a maximum of 32 characters. You must enter a name
before you can save the new heat pump loop. You can modify the
name at any time from the Setup screen of the Heat Pump Loop edi-
tor.
4. Click OK. The Heat Pump Loop editor Setup screen displays (see Fig-
ure 293 on page 330).
BMTX-SVP01A-EN 329
Heat Pump Loop Control
Note:
The Enable Startup referencer field allows you to have the loop
pre-heated or pre-cooled in advance of start up of the water
source heat pumps.
4. Check the Continuous Operation check box if you want the water loop
to operate continuously. If this is checked, the Tracer loop controller is
always in the occupied mode, regardless of individual WSHP sched-
ules or need-to-run.
330 BMTX-SVP01A-EN
Setting Up the Heat Pump Loop Control Object
Note:
The WSHP referencer is used to monitor water loop operation
and lock out compressor operation of the heat pumps when the
loop is not operating properly. When a Tracer loop controller is
used, the Compressor Control: Active property is automatically
referenced. When a PCM or UPCM is used as the loop control-
ler, an appropriate referencer needs to be assigned. This could
be a pump output, loop flow status, or a binary value that is set
once all loop operation, including pumps, boilers and towers are
proven.
BMTX-SVP01A-EN 331
Heat Pump Loop Control
2. Click the Security Classes button. The Change Security Classes dia-
log box displays (see Figure 295).
3. Click the Access field next to each class to grant or deny access to the
security class. A check in the field grants access. If unchecked, per-
mission to the security class is denied.
4. Click OK to close the Change Security Class dialog box and display
the Classes screen.
332 BMTX-SVP01A-EN
Chapter 23
Time of day scheduling in Tracer Summit enables you to create and mod-
ify schedules that control HVAC equipment and lighting. It also gives you
the flexibility to create time of day schedule reports from the scheduling
screen (see “Creating Time of Day Schedule Reports” on page 348).
Using the scheduling application, you can schedule equipment to start or
stop at specific times during the day. You can use optimal start and stop
times to turn equipment on as late as possible and turn it off as early as
possible, while maintaining the desired comfort level in a defined zone or
building.
You modify schedules using the Scheduling screen. A schedule is a set of
defined events that applies to an effective period of time for one or more of
the following:
• Areas
• UCMs
• Control points
• Set values
A schedule has a normal day defined for each day of the week. A normal
day applies unless you create a holiday or an exception. Holidays take
precedence over normal days, and exceptions take precedence over holi-
days and normal days.
You can define more than one set of events in a schedule for a site, and an
object can be a member of more than one event in a schedule. However, an
object cannot be active during two events simultaneously. For example, if
a UCM is a member of one event that starts at 8 a.m. and stops at 5 p.m.,
it cannot be a member of another event that would require it to start at
7 a.m. and stop at 4 p.m.
The Tracer 100/Tracker Communications package enables you to upload
Tracer 100 schedules, edit them, and then download them to Tracer 100
panels. For more information, see “Using Tracer 100 Schedules” on
page 346.
BMTX-SVP01A-EN 333
Time of Day Scheduling
Indicates Optimal
Start/Occupied
schedule Occupied
period
Indicates Night
Economize Optimal
Start period
Indicates Lighting for
BCU sites or Duty
Cycle for T100 sites
Note:
If you need help with time of day scheduling, refer to the Daily
Operations tutorial, Focus on Your System. (For information
about using the tutorial, refer to the Tracer Summit Daily
Operations guide.
334 BMTX-SVP01A-EN
Creating a New Daily Schedule
Note:
The scheduling application can create new schedules for BCU
sites only. You can create new schedules for Tracer 100 sites
from the terminal emulation screen and from doing a system
expansion on the Tracer 100 panel (see “Deleting a Tracer 100
Schedule from the Workstation” on page 347). After this is
done, scan the Tracer 100 panel for the new schedules. For
more information about scanning Tracer 100 panels, see “Run
Immediate Scan on a Single Site” on page 205.
4. Type the name of the new schedule in the Schedule Name field.
5. Specify the Start Date using the up and down arrows. (The start date
defaults to the selected date.)
6. Leave the No End Date check box selected if you do not want to spec-
ify an end date.
To specify an end date, uncheck the box to activate the End Date field.
Then, use the up and down arrows to specify the end date.
BMTX-SVP01A-EN 335
Time of Day Scheduling
7. Click Next. The second Schedule Wizard dialog box displays (see
Figure 298).
8. Click the Member Types selection arrow to display the list of member
types.
9. Select the desired member type to display in the Available Members
list.
10. In the Available Members list, select the members to which you want
the schedule to apply.
11. Click Add to add the members to the Selected Members list. To add
all available members to the Selected Members list, click Add All.
12. Click Next. The Schedule Wizard—Select Events Schedule Responds
To dialog box displays (see Figure 299 on page 337).
336 BMTX-SVP01A-EN
Creating a New Daily Schedule
Note:
If a schedule contains a mixture of Normal and Optimal events
(such as an Optimal Start and Normal Stop), the members
must be set up as Normal and Optimal.
13. For each member in the Schedules column, define the schedule event
types by selecting the check boxes under the desired column head-
ings. See Table 8 for an explanation of the direct relationship between
schedule member types and event types.
Schedule Member
Type Member Type Events
BMTX-SVP01A-EN 337
Time of Day Scheduling
14. Click Next. The Schedule Wizard—Set Default Event Times dialog
box displays (see Figure 300).
15. For Normal, Optimal, and Lighting events, click the desired check
boxes. Then, set the Start Event and Stop Event times, using the up
and down arrows.
16. To schedule a start time and duration for the Night Economize event,
click the Schedule Night Economize Events check box. Then, set the
start time using the up and down arrows and enter the length of the
event time in the Duration field.
17. To change the set analog start time, click the Set Analog Selected
check box. Then, set the start time using the up and down arrows and
enter the setpoint value in the Value field.
338 BMTX-SVP01A-EN
Creating a New Daily Schedule
18. Click Next. The final Schedule Wizard dialog box displays (see
Figure 301).
19. Click the check box for each day of the week on which you want the
schedule to be effective. The Monday, Tuesday, Wednesday, Thursday,
and Friday boxes are checked as defaults.
20. Click Finish. The Save New Schedule dialog box displays (see
Figure 302).
21. Click the BCU Name selection arrow to display the list of available
BCUs.
22. Select the BCU to which you want to save the schedule.
23. Click OK to display the Scheduling screen and the new schedule.
BMTX-SVP01A-EN 339
Time of Day Scheduling
340 BMTX-SVP01A-EN
Adding an Event to a Schedule
3. Select the event you want to add. Depending on the event you select,
a dialog box appears for that event. For example, after you click one of
the time bars, a Change Event Times dialog box similar to the one in
Figure 305 appears. Depending on the event type that you choose to
add, the fields that display in the dialog box vary.
Note:
Because Tracer 100 panels limit events, the Time of Day Sched-
ule application only lets you add up to six events each day in
the schedule.
BMTX-SVP01A-EN 341
Time of Day Scheduling
342 BMTX-SVP01A-EN
Adding a Member to a Schedule
3. Select Add Members. The Add Members to Schedule dialog box dis-
plays (see Figure 309).
4. Click the Member Types selection arrow to display the list of member
types.
5. Select the desired member type to display in the Available Members
list.
BMTX-SVP01A-EN 343
Time of Day Scheduling
6. Select the member(s) you want to add to the schedule from the Avail-
able Members list.
7. Click Add to add the member(s) to the Selected Members list. To add
all available members to the Members to Add list, click Add All.
8. Click OK.
344 BMTX-SVP01A-EN
Changing a Schedule’s Effective Period
5. Set or modify the Start Advance time and Stop Delay time using the
up and down arrows.
6. Click OK.
BMTX-SVP01A-EN 345
Time of Day Scheduling
346 BMTX-SVP01A-EN
Using Tracer 100 Schedules
BMTX-SVP01A-EN 347
Time of Day Scheduling
Note:
This report is also available in the standard site reports. For
more information about standard site reports see “Designing
Reports” on page 495.
348 BMTX-SVP01A-EN
Creating Time of Day Schedule Reports
BMTX-SVP01A-EN 349
Time of Day Scheduling
5. From the Available Schedules for Selected Period list, select the
schedules that you want to include in your report.
6. Click the Add button to add those schedules to the Selected Schedules
list.
Note:
To remove a schedule from the list click the Remove button.
7. Click the Finish button to create the time of day schedule report.
350 BMTX-SVP01A-EN
Chapter 24
Custom Programming
Language
Note:
For detailed information on specific CPL statements, functions,
enumerations and so on, refer to Tracer Summit online help.
Tracer Summit includes a library of sample programs located
in the folder C:\Program Files\Tracer Summit\cpl\library.
You can also locate the sample programs in the Tracer Summit
electronic library on the Tracer Summit CD (for more informa-
tion, see Chapter 5, “Utilities”).
There are four basic steps used to successfully create and test a CPL pro-
gram object:
1. Create or Edit the CPL text file. CPL text files are created and
edited using the CPL editor and saved to the PC Workstation data-
base.
2. Compile the CPL text file. The compiler checks for any syntax
errors. After the syntax errors are corrected, you can compile the text
file again. This process is repeated until it successfully compiles, at
which point it is an executable CPL program.
3. Create the CPL Object in the Database. A successfully compiled
CPL program is used either to create a new CPL object or replace an
existing CPL object in the system database. During this step, a run
frequency (if any) and the BCU where this program executes are
assigned. The newly created CPL object is automatically sent to the
BCU when the workstation is online.
4. Test the CPL Program. Once the CPL object is sent to the BCU, use
the CPL editor to step through the program and test its logic.
BMTX-SVP01A-EN 351
Custom Programming Language
352 BMTX-SVP01A-EN
Creating or Editing a CPL Text File
3. Select the desired CPL file. For a new routine, you can use the
Header.cpl file, which has the recommended program structure.
4. Click Open to load the file into the CPL editor (see Figure 317 on page
354).
BMTX-SVP01A-EN 353
Custom Programming Language
5. Add the program name and text to the comment lines to define your
program (see the section “Adding Comments” on page 356 for more
details).
6. If applicable, use the predefined place in the Header.cpl file to define
variables for the new program.
7. Using the Edit menu items for proper CPL syntax, insert the control
statements and calculations that the program will use (see
Figure 318 on page 355).
354 BMTX-SVP01A-EN
Creating or Editing a CPL Text File
Note:
If special startup sequences are required after a power failure,
naming a CPL program object “STARTUP_1”, “STARTUP_2”,
etc., causes the program(s) to execute before all other applica-
tions execute after power is restored on the BCU.
12. Click OK to save your CPL file to the PC Workstation. Save the file
frequently during editing to avoid losing your work.
BMTX-SVP01A-EN 355
Custom Programming Language
Adding Comments
You must manually add comments to your CPL text file to explain the
program steps. Comments will help you and others understand and debug
the program later. There are two types of comments you can add:
• Comment lines beginning with /// use memory in the BCU.
Type /// at the beginning of comment lines that you want to save to the
BCU. These comments remain in the program after it is compiled and
sent to the BCU. You see the comments when you open the CPL
object.
• Comment lines beginning with // do not use BCU memory.
Type // at the beginning of comments lines that you want stored only
in the CPL text file. This saves space in the BCU since these com-
ments are removed when the program is created as an object.
Adding Statements
1. Position the cursor in the CPL text file where you want to insert the
statement.
2. From the Edit menu, select Add Statement. The Add Statement dia-
log box displays (see Figure 319 on page 357).
356 BMTX-SVP01A-EN
Creating or Editing a CPL Text File
Adding Functions
1. Put your cursor in the CPL text file where you want to insert the
statement.
2. From the Edit menu, select Add Function. The Add Function dialog
box displays (see Figure 320).
BMTX-SVP01A-EN 357
Custom Programming Language
Note:
The compiler will ignore spaces, tabs, and blank lines, but you
must avoid carriage returns or word wrap (where the editor
puts a dash mark to finish the word on the next line) when
denoting an object name or property name in your file. The
names of objects and properties used in the program must
exactly match the names in the database.
3. Select the object type and object name you want to insert.
4. Click OK to insert the object reference into your CPL text file.
358 BMTX-SVP01A-EN
Creating or Editing a CPL Text File
Note:
Variable names are case sensitive. For example, the compiler
sees the names OAT and oat as different variables.
BMTX-SVP01A-EN 359
Custom Programming Language
Note:
Variable names are case sensitive. For example, the compiler
sees the names OAT and oat as different variables.
360 BMTX-SVP01A-EN
Creating or Editing a CPL Text File
3. Select the object type, name, and property you want to insert.
4. Click OK to insert the property reference into your CPL text file.
Assigning Enumerations
Tracer Summit treats all binary and multi-state properties as integers.
On is usually a 1 and Off is 0. These associations between words and inte-
gers are called enumerations. It is critical that the enumeration, once
defined, appear the same throughout the entire program (identical spell-
ing and capitalization).
To assign enumerations:
1. From the Edit menu, select Add Enum Bool. The Select Property Ref-
erence dialog box displays.
2. Select the desired property from the list.
3. Click OK. The Enumeration/Boolean dialog box displays (see
Figure 324).
BMTX-SVP01A-EN 361
Custom Programming Language
362 BMTX-SVP01A-EN
Creating or Editing a CPL Text File
/// This CPL object uses the text file named AHU1SD.CPL
Defint
On = 1, // Define enumerations
Off = 0
If ({AHU1 ALARM}.{Present Value} = On) Then
// If alarm switch is turned On
Control ({AHU1 PCM}, {Present Value}, 6, 2, SET)
// Turn the AHU Off
Else
// If alarm switch is turned Off
Control ({AHU1 PCM}, {Present Value}, 6, 2, RELEASE)
// Release the AHU to normal control
End If
End
Example: After Enumerated Booleans Program
This is the same CPL text file after the CPL editor assigns the enumera-
tion (the changes are in boldface type).
Defint Priority_Shutdown = 6
Program AHU1_SHUTDOWN
// Written: December 15, 1992 by Ryan Smith
// Modifications:
// None
//
// Properties modified:
//{AHU1 PCM}.{Present Value}
/// This program is executed by Binary Input AHU1 ALARM;
/// therefore, the frequency should be set at 0 seconds.
/// This program turns the AHU Off anytime the binary input
/// AHU1 ALARM is turned On.
/// This CPL object uses the text file named AHU1SD.CPL
Defint
On = 1, // Define enumerations
Off = 0
IF ({AHU1 ALARM}.{Present Value} = On) Then
// If alarm switch is turned On
Control ({AHU1 PCM}, {Present Value}, Priority_Shutdown, 2, SET)
// Turn the AHU Off
Else
// If alarm switch is turned Off
Control ({AHU1 PCM}, {Present Value}, Priority_Shutdown, 2, RELEASE)
// Release the AHU to normal control
End If
End
BMTX-SVP01A-EN 363
Custom Programming Language
Using Arrays
Tracer Summit CPL allows arrays of objects and/or properties to be cre-
ated to reduce the number of CPL statements needed for a CPL program.
Arrays also make it easier to edit a CPL program once it has been created
by arranging objects and properties in a specific order. Arrays are typi-
cally used in CPL programs where repetitive calculations are performed
(such as programs that use FOR...NEXT statements).
The syntax for defining an array that points to objects and their proper-
ties is:
Defint BIP[6]
BIP[1]={object A}.{property}
BIP[2]={object B}.{property}
BIP[3]={object C}.{property}
BIP[4]={object D}.{property}
BIP[5]={object E}.{property}
BIP[6]={object F}.{property}
364 BMTX-SVP01A-EN
Creating or Editing a CPL Text File
DEFINT
Off = 0, // Enumeration for Off
On = 1, // Enumeration for On
NUMB = 6, // Define number of binary inputs and outputs
BIPS[NUMB], // Define array for binary inputs
i // Define index for FOR-NEXT statement
DEFOBJ
BOPS[NUMB]// Define array of binary outputs that will
// match the binary inputs
End If
Next
End
BMTX-SVP01A-EN 365
Custom Programming Language
the program or otherwise a new value must be calculated each time the
CPL program runs.
An analog or binary input can be set up to reference a CPL saved value
and alarm if it exceeds the alarm limits (refer to Chapter 16, “Creating
Input/Output Objects”, for more information on setting up analog inputs).
To read or write a local saved value in your program:
1. Position the cursor where you want the saved value to reside.
2. From the Edit menu, select Add Statement.
3. Select LOCAL.{SAVED VALUE}[ ]
4. Click OK to insert the following line into your program:
Local.{Saved Value}[ ]
5. Add a number within the square bracket to indicate the array num-
ber of the saved value (1-16).
To read or write a saved value from another CPL program:
1. Position the cursor where you want the saved value to reside.
2. From the Edit menu, select Add Obj&Property. The Select Property
Reference dialog box displays.
3. Select the CPL program object from the Type list.
4. Select the CPL program name from the Name list.
5. Select the Saved Value [#] you want to reference from the property
list (see Figure 325).
6. Click OK. The CPL editor will insert the statement. For example:
{Chiller_Control}.{Saved Value}[7]
366 BMTX-SVP01A-EN
Creating or Editing a CPL Text File
Defint
Off = 0,//Enumeration for Off
On = 1,//Enumeration for On
Timer_1
// If space temperature is 1 F above setpoint, start 10 minute timer
Timer_1 = Local.{Saved Value}[1]
If
({Warehouse Temperature}.{Present Value} > ({Warehouse Exhaust Fan Set-
point}.{Present Value} +1))
Then
Timer_1 = Timer_1 + 1
Else
Timer_1 = 0
End If
// Control the exhaust fan On or Off
If (Timer_1 > 10) Then
Control({Exhaust Fan1}, {Present Value}, On, 5, SET)
Else
Control({Exhaust Fan1}, {Present Value}, Off, 5, SET)
End If
// Store Timer value for the next execution
Local.{Saved Value}[1] = Timer_1
End
BMTX-SVP01A-EN 367
Custom Programming Language
3. Double click on the line listed in the Compile Report dialog box to go
to that line and fix the errors, or use the Go To Line command on the
Edit menu.
Depending on how the text file was edited, the line given as the loca-
tion of the syntax error may actually be the line after the location
where the error occurred. Therefore, look at the line indicated and the
lines before it when looking for syntax errors.
4. After you make your corrections, save the file.
5. Run the compile function again. Repeat this cycle (steps 2 - 4) until
the Compile Report dialog box displays “Successful Compile,” indicat-
ing that there are no errors (see Figure 327 on page 369).
368 BMTX-SVP01A-EN
Creating a CPL Object in the Database
Note:
In addition to errors, this dialog box also displays warnings. Pro-
grams can successfully compile when warnings are generated.
They fail if errors are generated.
6. After compiling successfully, click Close.
7. Save the CPL text file again. It is important to save the file after a
successful compile.
BMTX-SVP01A-EN 369
Custom Programming Language
The default name displays in the Program Name field. This is the
name from the program statement of the CPL text file. Do not change
the name.
2. From the BCU drop-down list, select the BCU where the CPL pro-
gram object will be stored. Store the CPL object in the same BCU that
most of the objects and properties referenced in the CPL program
reside.
3. Define the frequency with which the CPL program runs. To set this
frequency click the up/down arrows on the right side of each box. It is
recommended that CPL programs run no faster than once every 30
seconds. Normally, programs run every minute, every hour, every day,
or are event-driven, based on the functions performed in the CPL pro-
gram.
4. To assign security classes click Security Classes. (For more informa-
tion on assigning security classes, refer to Chapter 10, “Setting Up
Security—Tracer Summit System.”)
370 BMTX-SVP01A-EN
Creating a CPL Object in the Database
5. On the CPL Program Creation editor dialog box, click Create to create
the CPL object and return to the CPL editor.
A Status dialog box displays stating whether sending the CPL object
to the BCU was successful. If the PC Workstation is online with the
BCU, a “Successful Operation Online” message displays. If the PC
Workstation is offline, the CPL editor sends the CPL object to the PC
Workstation database, and a “Successful Operation Offline” message
displays. When the PC Workstation goes online, it sends the CPL
object to the selected BCU.
BMTX-SVP01A-EN 371
Custom Programming Language
Note:
• In the CPL Program Replacement editor dialog box, the BCU
field is unavailable, because the program is being replaced at
the BCU where the previous program object resides.
• The default name displays in the Program Name field which is
the name of the CPL object. Do not change the name.
4. Define the frequency with which the CPL program runs. To set the
frequency click the up/down arrows on the right side of each box. It is
recommended that CPL programs run no faster than once every 30
seconds. Normally, programs run every minute, every hour, every day,
or are event-driven, based on the functions performed in the CPL pro-
gram.
5. To assign security classes, click Security Classes. (For more informa-
tion on assigning security classes, refer to Chapter 10, “Setting Up
Security—Tracer Summit System”.)
6. At the CPL Program Replacement editor, click OK to replace the CPL
object and return to the CPL editor.
A Status dialog box displays stating whether sending the CPL object
to the BCU was successful. If the PC Workstation is online with the
BCU, a “Successful Operation Online” message displays. If the PC
Workstation is offline, the CPL editor sends the CPL object to the PC
Workstation database and a “Successful Operation Offline” message
displays. When the PC Workstation goes online, it sends the CPL
object to the selected BCU.
372 BMTX-SVP01A-EN
Testing a CPL Program
Note:
When a CPL program is in the debug mode, WAIT statements are
executed. For longer WAIT statements, it is recommended that
they temporarily be shortened or commented out (insert “//” or “///”
in front of the statement and recompile) before testing the CPL
program.
You will usually encounter two kinds of problems when testing a CPL pro-
gram:
• The program results in the wrong values for the program variables.
• The program halts because of a runtime error. Runtime errors are
errors that do not appear when a program is compiled, but do appear
when the program is executed.
Testing a CPL program will help you identify and resolve both types of
problems.
To test a CPL program:
1. From the Test menu, select Start Debug. The Select CPL Program
dialog box displays (see Figure 331).
2. Select the program you want to test. Then click OK or double click the
desired program.
The background color of the CPL editor changes to cyan when the edi-
tor is in the debug (or test) mode. The first line of the program will be
highlighted, indicating that the test mode is ready to execute.
BMTX-SVP01A-EN 373
Custom Programming Language
Note:
• When a CPL program is in the debug mode, the programmer is
manually running the CPL program. All outputs from the pro-
gram are performed unless the Inhibit DB Writes menu item
is selected.
• Inhibit DB Writes will prevent the program from writing to
the database, and prevent any control functions of the pro-
gram. The calculations contained in the program will be per-
formed as intended, but no outputs will be sent out.
4. If necessary, use the Set Breakpoint function on the Test menu to
manually enter a point in the program at which the program execu-
tion will stop.
A break is useful at a point in the program just before a problem area,
or for an area that you want to test more slowly by stepping through
line-by-line.
For example, to test a program you can insert a break just before a
problem area in the program. To begin the test, from the Test menu
select Run. When the program stops at the set break point, use the
Step function to execute the program line by line from that point.
5. Use the Run or Step items on the Test menu to execute the program
test.
If you click Step, only one line of the program executes. If you select
Run, the editor tries to execute the entire program until it hits a
Break or the End statement, or until a runtime error occurs.
6. From the Test menu, select View Variable. The Variable Viewer dialog
box displays (see Figure 332 on page 375).
374 BMTX-SVP01A-EN
Testing a CPL Program
7. When you encounter a problem that involves editing the CPL pro-
gram, from the Test menu, select Stop Debug. If the program encoun-
ters a runtime error, see the section “CPL Error Codes” on page 376
for explanations of the error codes and possible solutions.
8. Load the original CPL text file back into the CPL editor. You should
not use the decompiled program used for the test to do your edits. The
original CPL text file contains the all the extra comment lines that
are not saved in the compiled program.
9. Edit the CPL text file to fix the problems encountered during the test.
10. Compile the program (see “Compiling a CPL Text File” on page 368).
11. Replace the CPL object in the database (see “Replacing an Existing
CPL Object in the Database” on page 371).
12. Test the new CPL program again. Repeat these steps for testing a
CPL program until the program runs properly and gives the desired
results.
BMTX-SVP01A-EN 375
Custom Programming Language
Error-30 Requested unit is down. The CPL object is trying to access a property in a BCU
that is currently not available.
Error-39 An invalid index was provided for The array of Local.{Saved Value} properties in each CPL
accessing an array element. object has only 16 elements. Trying to access element
17 or higher causes this error. For example, the follow-
ing compiles, but causes this error.
Num=21
For I=1 to Num step 1
Local.{Saved Value}[i]=VAV[i].{Zone Temperature}
Next
Error-103 The CPL program’s Get Property table The property referred to in the CPL routine could not be
entry call failed. found for that object.
Error-250 The CPL program has a bad symbol Recompile and replace the CPL object.
type.
Error-251 The CPL program has a bad expression A bad expression exists in the routine. A common error
stack. is to forget to add the property in a statement that is
intended for testing the property. For example,
If ({Area 1} = 2) Then
rather than
If ({Area 1}.{Present Value}= 2) Then
Error-252 CPL program has a bad program stack. Adjust the Context Size property of the CPL object. The
default context size is 624. Change the value from 624 to
1248. If the error still occurs, change the value to 1872. If
the routine then runs, change the value to 1560. Keep
adjusting the value to find the proper context size.
Error-253 CPL program has an invalid symbol Recompile and replace the CPL object.
stack offset.
Error-254 CPL program has a bad BCX_ITRP exe- Recompile and replace the CPL object.
cution queue or the entry was not found.
Error-255 The CPL program has an invalid/unsup- Recompile and replace the CPL object.
ported token operation.
Error-256 The CPL program has a general problem Recompile and replace the CPL object.
with a symbol.
Error-257 The CPL program has overflowed its P Adjust the Context Size property of the CPL object. The
stack or E stack. default context size is 624. Change the value from 624 to
1248. If the error still occurs, change the value to 1872. If
the routine then runs, change the value to 1560. Keep
adjusting the value to find the proper context size.
376 BMTX-SVP01A-EN
CPL Error Codes
Error-258 CPL program has an array index that is An array index is too big or too small. You may have
out of bounds. defined the array to have three elements, and then tried
to perform an operation on array element four. Also
remember that 0 is not a valid array index.
Error-259 The CPL program has a bad assignment Recompile and replace the CPL object.
(usually unequal types).
Error-260 The CPL program has an unknown Recompile and replace the CPL object.
token.
Error-261 The CPL program has a BCX_ITRP that Recompile and replace the CPL object.
had a problem looking up symbol (usu-
ally invalid type).
Error-262 The CPL program parameter and argu- Recompile and replace the CPL object.
ment types do not match.
Error-263 The CPL program has underflowed its Recompile and replace the CPL object.
expression evaluation stack.
Error-264 The CPL program has underflowed its Recompile and replace the CPL object.
program stack.
Error-265 The CPL program (or BCX_ITRP) has Recompile and replace the CPL object.
problem with nested If statements.
Error-266 The CPL program has attempted to Debug the routine to find where the divide by zero error
divide by zero. is occurring. Determine whether a variable is not being
initialized (variables are always 0 unless initialized to
another value). Question whether the MIN/MAX opera-
tors or an IF-THEN statement can be used to prevent the
variable in the denominator from going to 0.
Error-267 The CPL program has a bad storage Recompile and replace the CPL object.
address for symbol.
Error-268 The CPL program is too small to be cor- Recompile and replace the CPL object.
rect.
Error-269 The CPL context is too small to be cor- Recompile and replace the CPL object.
rect.
Error-307 An invalid property size was given. Debug the routine to find where the property size error
is occurring. A common error is controlling a binary
output to a value other than 0 or 1.
BMTX-SVP01A-EN 377
Custom Programming Language
378 BMTX-SVP01A-EN
Chapter 25
The navigation tree is a convenient and intuitive way for users to find and
display information in Tracer Summit. The navigation tree displays next
to the Tracer Summit application window. Daily operators can see where
they are in the system and where they can go. Daily operators can also
use the navigation tree to connect with sites or gather information about
their system.
The ability to connect to Tracer 100 and Tracker sites by double-clicking
is available in the Tracer 100/Tracker Communication and Enterprise
Management packages. Connecting to BCU sites by double-clicking a
node on the navigation tree is available in Tracer Summit as a standard
feature.
Each item on the tree is called a node. For a description of nodes and their
functions, see “Different Types of Nodes” on page 381. Nodes appear auto-
matically as you build sites and add objects. To make your navigation tree
logical and easy to use, arrange the tree to represent the way your organi-
zation is set up. For example, if sites are organized in geographical
regions, arrange nodes based on this geographical layout.
Depending on security level, users can:
• Rearrange an existing navigation tree using drag and drop and cut
and paste commands
• Connect to or disconnect from a site
• Add and remove nodes
• Change the graphic associated with a UCM, area, or site
Note:
Except for systems with shared databases, the navigation tree
is unique to each workstation. You cannot change a navigation
tree on one workstation and have these changes reflected auto-
matically on another workstation. To copy navigation tree
changes from one workstation to another, back up the site data-
base of the workstation where you made the changes and
restore it to the other workstation.
BMTX-SVP01A-EN 379
Using the Navigation Tree
Figure 333. Sample View of the Navigation Tree with Various Nodes
System node
Group of sites node
Tracer 100 site node
Panel node
Macro node
Tracer Summit BCU
site node
Area node
UCM nodes
Custom global
graphic node
380 BMTX-SVP01A-EN
Different Types of Nodes
Note:
In the following paragraphs, we refer to connecting to a site by
double-clicking a site node on the navigation tree. Connecting
to sites automatically when you double-click on them is set up
in the System Options editor (see “Setting Connection Features
of the Navigation Tree” on page 528). For more information, see
“Connecting to a Site from the Tree” on page 383.
System The Tracer Summit system node belongs to the system. All other nodes are
inside the system node. The system node is the collection of all site nodes.
Tracer Summit A site node is any site in the system that belongs to the system. Site nodes
BCU Site display after you create, restore, or upload a site.
When you double-click on a site node, its linked graphic appears in the appli-
Tracer 100 Site cation window. Double-click the site node again to connect to it or to program
off-line.
Tracker Site When you connect to a Tracer 100 or Tracker site, the terminal emulation
screen appears. When the site is a multiple-panel Tracer 100 unit-to-unit site,
the panel to which you connect is unit 1 (the COP).
Panel A panel node appears for each remote unit that you create for legacy Tracer
100 and Tracker sites. Double-click a panel node to connect to it or to pro-
gram off-line.
Group of Sites; The group of sites node is a collection of sites. It is a custom global graphic
also known as a node belonging to the system site. A group of sites node differs from a cus-
Custom Global tom global graphic node in the following way. A group of sites node has at
Graphic Without site least one site node inside it. The custom global graphic node has no site
nodes, nodes inside it. The group of sites node is not associated with groups.
appears as: When you double-click a group of sites node, its linked graphic displays in the
... application window.
Custom Site … The custom site graphic node is found inside a site node. When you double-
Graphic click a custom site graphic node, its linked graphic displays in the application
window. You can also double-click the node to connect to it or to program
off-line.
Area Node … An area node appears for each area defined in a BCU site. UCM and custom
site graphic nodes are commonly found inside area nodes. Double-click an
area node to see its linked graphic in the application window. If you are not
connected already, the Tracer Summit software also connects you to the site
to which the area node belongs.
BMTX-SVP01A-EN 381
Using the Navigation Tree
Table 10. Navigation Tree Nodes: Types, Icons, and Descriptions (Continued)
UCM Node … A UCM node appears for each UCM defined in a BCU site. UCM nodes are
grouped together, most often inside area or custom site graphic nodes. Dou-
ble-click a UCM node to see its linked graphic in the application window. If
you are not connected already, the Tracer Summit software also connects
you to the site to which the UCM belongs.
Macro … Macro nodes are found inside Tracer 100 and Tracker sites. When you are
connected to a site and you double-click a macro node, it runs regardless of
what site panel is active.
382 BMTX-SVP01A-EN
Using the Navigation Tree
Note:
The advanced option for connecting automatically might not
work due to workstation hardware limitations. For example, if
your workstation does not have enough modems to communi-
cate simultaneously with every remote site, the system displays
an error message.
Closing a Site
◆ With the site open, from the Connect menu select Close Site.
BMTX-SVP01A-EN 383
Using the Navigation Tree
Note:
Use the Refresh command as a quick way to collapse all nodes
in the tree.
Creating Nodes
There are several ways to create nodes. These include site configuration,
site uploads, site restorations, the Area editor, the Keyboard Macro editor,
restoring graphics, and the Graphics editor. Once you add nodes to the
tree, you can further modify them by cutting and pasting or dragging and
dropping them inside other nodes.
384 BMTX-SVP01A-EN
Creating Nodes
BMTX-SVP01A-EN 385
Using the Navigation Tree
more information, see “Creating a Remote Unit for Tracer 100 Sites”
on page 126 and “Creating a Keyboard Macro” on page 397.
Grouping Nodes
Group nodes to better organize your site. For example, create a custom
site graphic titled UCMs and then group all UCMs under the graphic
node.
To group nodes:
1. Click the first node and left-click the mouse.
2. Drag it onto the second node.
3. Release the left mouse button. The first node moves inside the second
node.
Finding a Node
Use the following procedure to find a node. For example, if you want to
find a specific piece of equipment but have forgotten which site it belongs
to, use Find.
Tracer Summit does not search sites for which you do not have security
access. If you use Find to locate a node that is inside a site to which you do
not have access, then Tracer Summit will not find the node for you.
Any user, except Nobody Logged On, can find nodes outside the site level,
regardless of their security level. Nodes that exist outside the site level
include custom global graphic, group of sites, and site.
To find a node on the navigation tree:
1. From the Tree menu, select Find. The Find Item in Tree dialog box
displays.
2. Type the name of the node that you are looking for in the Look for
field. Use wildcards if you want. (See online Help for information on
wildcard search commands.)
3. Click Find. The Tracer Summit software searches for the node and
highlights it when found. Otherwise, a dialog box informs you that
the node was not found.
4. Click Close.
386 BMTX-SVP01A-EN
Modifying the Tree
3. Select the type of graphic that you want to use for the selected node:
• Click Standard for a list of available standard graphics.
• Click Site for a list of site-only graphics (graphics created just for
the site where the selected node resides).
• Click Global to display a list of available global standard and cus-
tom graphics.
BMTX-SVP01A-EN 387
Using the Navigation Tree
4. From the Graphics list, select the graphic you want to assign to this
node.
5. Click OK to link the node to the selected graphic.
Removing Node(s)
You can remove custom graphic, UCM, area, and macro objects from the
navigation tree. You cannot remove the system node, site nodes, or Tracer
100 and Tracker panel nodes. To remove these, use the Delete Object util-
ity. For more information, see “Deleting a Site” on page 606.
For example, if you remove a custom graphic node that has UCMs in it,
the UCM nodes under the custom graphic node will also be removed.
If you try to remove a site node that has a macro inside it, the macro node
cannot be removed. Therefore, it relocates inside a higher level site node
or inside the system node.
To remove a node from the navigation tree:
1. Click the node(s) that you want to remove.
2. From the Tree menu, select Remove Graphic/Remove Macro.
If the selected node has nodes inside it, the Node Removal Confirma-
tion dialog box appears asking you whether you are sure you want to
remove the node and all nodes under it.
3. Click OK on the Node Removal Confirmation dialog box. The nodes
are removed from the tree.
388 BMTX-SVP01A-EN
Modifying the Tree
Note:
• A graphical node can only appear in the tree once.
• Any macro node can be shared between many sites, so it
might appear in several sites at a time.
Note:
Since the tree automatically sorts nodes alphanumerically, the
node might not appear in the spot you wanted it. In that case,
drag and drop or cut and paste it where it belongs.
BMTX-SVP01A-EN 389
Using the Navigation Tree
390 BMTX-SVP01A-EN
Chapter 26
BMTX-SVP01A-EN 391
Connecting to Tracer 100 and Tracker EMTK Panels
IMPORTANT
Tracer Summit supports a connection to Tracer 100 panels at version
14.4 or higher and Tracker EMTK panels at version 5.0 or higher. You can
not connect to the new Tracker BMTK (Tracker III).
Note:
If you have several Tracer 100 or Trackers connected to the
Tracer Summit workstation, only one site can use the terminal
emulator at a time.
For more information about configuring the Tracer 100 or Tracker panel
for direct or modem connection, see the Tracer 100 Series Programming
guide (EMTB-PG-11), Tracer 100 Installation guide (EMTB-IN-12), or the
Installation Guide for Tracer 100i, Tracer L, and Tracer Chiller Plant
Manager (EMTF-IN-6).
392 BMTX-SVP01A-EN
Background Considerations for Connecting to Tracer 100 or Tracker EMTK Panels
Note:
• Expanding and collapsing the tree by clicking the + and -
symbols does not connect you to a site.
• When you configure the navigation tree to open a site auto-
matically when you double-click on it, the automatic con-
nection applies to all sites or no sites.
For more information about terminal emulation, see the Tracer 100 Daily
Operations guide.
For more information about selecting this capability in system options,
see “Setting Connection Features of the Navigation Tree” on page 528.
For information about the navigation tree and how it connects to Tracer
100 and Tracker panels, see “Connecting to a Site from the Tree” on
page 383.
BMTX-SVP01A-EN 393
Connecting to Tracer 100 and Tracker EMTK Panels
Note:
A SAV file differs from a .BDB file, which is created during
daily operations. A .BDB file contains the information that has
been scanned from the panel into the workstation database.
The .BDB file information for Tracer 100 or Tracker sites only
includes schedules, calculated binaries and analogs, and
generic points. A .SAV file, on the other hand, contains all the
information from the panel. The .SAV file is used to restore
Tracer 100 panels (see “Restoring a Tracer 100 Panel” on
page 616).
3. From the Remote Unit to Backup list, select the panel to back up.
Click the Browse button to select the directory where you want to
store the SAV file.
The name of the backup file will always be *.SAV, where * is the name
of the remote unit as defined in Tracer 100 site configuration.
394 BMTX-SVP01A-EN
Creating Keyboard Macros
4. Click OK. If you are not already connected to the site, Tracer Summit
connects to the panel and performs the backup. While the backup is
in process (which may take up to 15 minutes), you cannot perform
any other action in terminal emulation.
5. If Tracer Summit had to connect to the site, at the end of the backup,
a dialog box appears that asks whether you want to go online with the
panel. You must respond within two minutes or Tracer Summit dis-
connects.
BMTX-SVP01A-EN 395
Connecting to Tracer 100 and Tracker EMTK Panels
396 BMTX-SVP01A-EN
Creating Keyboard Macros
Note:
The Tracer 100 or Tracker terminal emulator application does
not validate keyboard macros that run during the session. The
Tracer Summit software assumes that you have properly set up
the macro to locate and find the correct location in the Tracer
100 or Tracker menu structure.
BMTX-SVP01A-EN 397
Connecting to Tracer 100 and Tracker EMTK Panels
Figure 339. Macro Reference Table Dialog Box and Pull-down Menu
3. From Submenu Options, select the desired macro (see Figure 340).
Figure 340. Macro Reference Table Dialog Box with a Selected Macro
398 BMTX-SVP01A-EN
Creating Keyboard Macros
4. Click OK. The Keyboard Macro editor appears (see Figure 338 on
page 396). The name of the macro displays in the Macro Name field.
The macro sequence displays in the Macro Sequence field.
5. In the Available Site(s) list, select the site(s) to which you want to
apply the macro.
6. Click Add to add the site(s) to the Selected Site(s) list.
7. Click Save. The macro object is saved to the database of the worksta-
tion. The navigation tree is updated to include the macro node under
the sites you specified.
BMTX-SVP01A-EN 399
Connecting to Tracer 100 and Tracker EMTK Panels
Acknowledge A
Help H
List L
Menu M
Next N
Panel Main Menu 9M
Previous P
400 BMTX-SVP01A-EN
List of Predefined Keystroke Macros
BMTX-SVP01A-EN 401
Connecting to Tracer 100 and Tracker EMTK Panels
402 BMTX-SVP01A-EN
List of Predefined Keystroke Macros
BMTX-SVP01A-EN 403
Connecting to Tracer 100 and Tracker EMTK Panels
404 BMTX-SVP01A-EN
List of Predefined Keystroke Macros
BMTX-SVP01A-EN 405
Connecting to Tracer 100 and Tracker EMTK Panels
406 BMTX-SVP01A-EN
Chapter 27
One of the most powerful tools available in Tracer Summit for Windows is
the Graphics editor, which allows you to create and customize graphics
(also called graphic objects) for your system with specialized tools and
menus. Graphics in Tracer Summit are the primary way in which daily
operators check system status and perform operator overrides.
Operators rely on the graphics you create to display information quickly
and clearly. You can create graphics to:
• Provide real-time status information about a particular object, or
about the system
• Give users the ability to change an object’s state or setpoint
• Display an animated image
As an advanced user, you can build and adapt graphics to be displayed
when an item is clicked on the navigation tree, when a target is clicked
within a graphic, and when the Graphic button is clicked in a UCM editor.
Using Tracer Summit’s Graphics editor, you can:
• Edit the standard graphics provided with Tracer Summit to use on
one or more sites as custom graphics
• Create new graphics
• Customize the background, font, size and appearance of fields on a
graphic, as well as the background of the graphic itself
• Create expanded messages
• Create runtime graphs for either live properties or trended objects
• Create links to external sources
For descriptions and information about specific fields, toolbar buttons,
dialog boxes, and palette buttons in the Graphics editor, see Tracer Sum-
mit online help.
BMTX-SVP01A-EN 407
Using the Graphics Editor
About Graphics
In Tracer Summit, you can create a graphic by adding graphic elements,
such as text (static or dynamic), images, target links to other graphics,
and controls, to a background image. A background image might be a
solid color or a floor plan of a site. You place layers of these graphic ele-
ments (also called fields) on the background to create a composite graphic.
You can also layer an animated image on top of another image, or place a
static text label on top of a control. Target fields layer over other images
to create links to other graphic objects. You can move intersecting layers
of images and other fields behind or in front of other layers. Figure 341
shows an example graphic.
Note:
• A graphic is linked to an object by its name. If you change
the name of an object that is referenced by a field on a
graphic, the graphic will be unable to display data for the
object. Instead, “Object Unavailable” will be displayed.
• All references to Windows folder names in this chapter
refer to subdirectories of the location where Tracer Sum-
mit is installed on your PC Workstation, which is typically
C:\Program Files\Tracer Summit. Subdirectories within
this folder include Graphics\Standard, Graphics\Custom
and Graphics\site name (where site name is the name of
the current site).
Target
Image
Target
Buttons
408 BMTX-SVP01A-EN
Accessing the Graphics Editor
The Graphics editor palette allows you to select from among 17 types of
fields to insert. Table 22 on page 410 shows the types of fields that are
available for insertion and configuration. When you click a palette button
or select a field for editing, an editor displays that provides configuration
options for the corresponding field type. More information about these
editors is available in Tracer Summit online help.
BMTX-SVP01A-EN 409
Using the Graphics Editor
Status Status text Inserts text drawn from the property you specify.
Fields
Analog in 5 color Inserts a field that shows the viewer a color-coded update of
the alarm state of an analog property you specify.
Binary Inserts text drawn from the binary property you specify.
Binary animation Inserts images to create animation from multiple image files
that run when the binary property is in a state you specify.
Control Override control Inserts a button with a text label you provide. In the runtime
Fields view, clicking the resulting button displays the Override dia-
log box, allowing users to alter the system via the graphic.
Setpoint control Inserts a numeric text field. In the runtime view, the field
allows users to change settings of numerical data.
Binary Check Box control Inserts an unchecked check box. In the runtime view, users
can check the check box to change the state of the property
you specify.
Selection List control Inserts a drop-down list that contains entries linked to a
property. In the runtime view, users can select from this list
to change the state of the associated property.
Text or
Static text Inserts text that you specify.
Image
Fields
AVI movie Inserts an AVI movie that runs for as long as the graphic is
displayed or until the movie ends.
410 BMTX-SVP01A-EN
Using the Graphics Editor Tools
Target
Target text Inserts a line of text that links to another graphic.
Fields
Target External Inserts a button that links to a Web site, a file, or an applica-
tion outside of Tracer Summit.
Graph field
Graphing Inserts a graph on the graphic.
Cursor
Default cursor Changes the cursor from an insertion point back to a selec-
tion cursor.
BMTX-SVP01A-EN 411
Using the Graphics Editor
412 BMTX-SVP01A-EN
Using the Graphics Editor Tools
BMTX-SVP01A-EN 413
Using the Graphics Editor
Note:
While you are in the Graphics editor, you can also access the
Graphic Properties dialog box from the graphics pop-up menu.
Move the mouse cursor so that it is not positioned over any
fields, then right-click to display the pop-up menu and select
Edit Properties.
414 BMTX-SVP01A-EN
Editing Graphic Properties
3. Click Browse to display the Locate Image dialog box (see Figure 346).
4. Select an image (see “Using the Locate Image Dialog Box” below).
5. Click OK to return to the Graphic Properties dialog box.
6. Click OK to return to the Graphics editor window.
BMTX-SVP01A-EN 415
Using the Graphics Editor
Note:
If images are not displaying properly in the Graphics editor,
your workstation’s Display settings in Windows might need cor-
rection. Your workstation must be set up for a minimum of 16-
bit colors. To check display settings, click the Windows Start
button. Click Settings, then Control Panel. From the Control
Panel, select Display.
416 BMTX-SVP01A-EN
Editing Graphic Properties
BMTX-SVP01A-EN 417
Using the Graphics Editor
4. Click the Security Classes button. The Change Security Classes dia-
log box displays (see Figure 349).
5. Click the Access field next to each class to grant or deny access. A
check in the field grants access. No check denies access.
6. Click OK to display the Classes screen.
7. Click Save.
Note:
The context object also will be used to fill in template fields on a
graphic when it is displayed. For more information on template
graphics, see “Creating and Modifying Graphics with Template
Fields” on page 454.
418 BMTX-SVP01A-EN
Editing Graphic Properties
4. In the Site Name field, select the site. To select the active site, select
<default>.
• If you select <default> for the site name, the Object Type and
Object Name fields display <default> also.
• If you choose a specific site name, the Object Type and Object
Name fields display the first type and name defined on the site.
5. In the Object Type field, select from the list of object types defined for
the site you specified.
6. In the Object Name field, select from the list of objects defined for the
site and object type you specified.
7. Click OK.
BMTX-SVP01A-EN 419
Using the Graphics Editor
3. Position the insert prompt at the location on the graphic where you
want to insert the field. Drag the prompt to define the shape and size
you want the field to be. The field is inserted and an editor appropri-
ate for the field type you selected displays.
Note:
For images and AVI movies, you can let Tracer Summit deter-
mine the field size based on the image size and proportion. Sim-
ply click once on the graphic to insert the field (rather than
dragging to define the field size). The field’s editor displays.
420 BMTX-SVP01A-EN
Creating and Editing Graphic Fields
2. Click the right mouse button to display a pop-up menu, then select
Edit Properties. An editor displays that corresponds to this field type.
3. Make changes to the information as necessary. Your edits take effect
when you click OK.
BMTX-SVP01A-EN 421
Using the Graphics Editor
422 BMTX-SVP01A-EN
Creating and Editing Graphic Fields
BMTX-SVP01A-EN 423
Using the Graphics Editor
424 BMTX-SVP01A-EN
Creating and Editing Graphic Fields
BMTX-SVP01A-EN 425
Using the Graphics Editor
Note:
You can not change the state an image represents after it has
been added. If you add an image in one state and want to
change it to the other state, delete the image. Select the state
you want it added to, then add the image.
• Click the up or down arrow button to change the order the frames are
displayed, as desired.
• In the Frame Delay field, specify the number of milliseconds you want
the frames to display. (This number applies to all of the images for the
animation. A lower number makes the animation appear faster.)
• To test the effect of the animation, click the Test Animation button.
426 BMTX-SVP01A-EN
Creating and Editing Graphic Fields
To select an image, click the Browse button and select one from the
Locate Image dialog box (see Figure 346 on page 415).
After you have selected an image, a sample displays on the Setup screen.
BMTX-SVP01A-EN 427
Using the Graphics Editor
Note:
Font styles and sizes vary by PC. You must ensure that the PC
Workstation that the graphic will be displayed on has the corre-
sponding font.
Note:
The number you enter here will take effect only if the graphic
field will display numeric information.
9. Click the Border tab. Figure 360 on page 429 shows the Border screen
for a status text field.
428 BMTX-SVP01A-EN
Creating and Editing Graphic Fields
10. In the Width field, select the width of the border (in pixels).
11. In the Style field, select the border’s style (such as solid, dotted or
dashed).
12. To change the color of the border from black, in the Color field, click
the Change button and select a color.
13. Click OK when you are finished.
BMTX-SVP01A-EN 429
Using the Graphics Editor
3. Click the right mouse button, then select Edit Properties from the
pop-up menu. The graphic field editor displays for that target field.
Figure 361 shows the Target Text editor.
Note:
If you select UCM/Application Objects, the context is supplied,
so the fields of the Context Object screen are not available. If
you select Graphic Objects, you need to select the context. See
“Selecting the Context Object for a Graphic” on page 418. On
the Context Object screen, make selections for the Site Name
and Object Name fields.
5. In the Site Name field, select the site that contains the UCM/Applica-
tion object or graphic you want users to see after they click this target
field in the current graphic.
6. In the Object Name field, select the name of the UCM or graphic you
want users to see after they click this target in the current graphic.
Note:
If you selected Graphic Objects in step 4, the Object Name field
changes to the Graphic Name field.
7. In the Editor Text field, select whether you want the target field to
display the destination object name or custom text.
8. If you want the second graphic to display in a separate window that
appears over the current graphic after the target field is clicked, click
430 BMTX-SVP01A-EN
Creating and Editing Graphic Fields
Open New Window. (Some users may not be able to make the selec-
tion to open a second graphic window due to their security level.)
9. Click OK when you are finished completing all the editor screens.
BMTX-SVP01A-EN 431
Using the Graphics Editor
6. In the Object Name field, select from the list of objects defined for the
site and object type you specified.
7. Click OK.
432 BMTX-SVP01A-EN
Creating and Editing Graphic Fields
5. Use the Style tab if you want to change the appearance of the button
(see “Editing Text Styles and Borders for Graphic Fields” on
page 427).
6. Click OK when you are finished completing the editor screens. The
Target External button will appear at the point where you positioned
the insert prompt (see step 2).
7. To edit the button, right-click on the button and select Edit Properties
from the pop-up menu.
BMTX-SVP01A-EN 433
Using the Graphics Editor
434 BMTX-SVP01A-EN
Organizing Graphic Fields
2. Drag the field to a new location within the graphic. All fields selected
with this field also move.
To move the field just one pixel at a time, press the left, right, up or
down arrow keys on your keyboard while the movement cursor is dis-
played.
When you release the mouse button, the default cursor returns.
3. Place the cursor at the location where you want to paste the field you
removed. This can be a location on the same graphic or on a different
graphic.
4. Click Paste Selected Field(s) on the Graphics editor toolbar to insert
the field in the new location (see Figure 367). The field is inserted at
the new location.
BMTX-SVP01A-EN 435
Using the Graphics Editor
3. Place the cursor at the location within the graphic where you want to
paste the field you copied. This can be a location on the same graphic
or on a different graphic.
4. Click Paste Selected Field(s) on the Graphics editor toolbar to insert
the field in the additional location (see Figure 367).
5. If additional configuration is required to distinguish the copied field
from the original field, complete this configuration.
436 BMTX-SVP01A-EN
Organizing Graphic Fields
Align
Left, Right, Top, Bottom
Make Same
Height, Width, Size
BMTX-SVP01A-EN 437
Using the Graphics Editor
438 BMTX-SVP01A-EN
Saving Graphics
Saving Graphics
You can save a graphic using the Save Graphic button on the Graphics
editor toolbar or using the Save Graphic command from the File menu.
When saving a graphic, keep in mind the following:
• For custom graphics, your changes overwrite the current graphic file.
• For standard graphics, your changes do not overwrite the original
standard graphic. Instead, they are saved into a graphic file of the
same name in the Graphics\Custom folder, which will override the
standard graphic.
• To save a graphic file to a new name or a different location, you can
use the Save Graphic As command. For custom graphics, refer to
“Saving a Custom Graphic to a New Location or File Name” below.
For standard graphics, refer to “Saving Edited Standard Graphics” on
page 440.
• The first time you save a custom graphic you created from a blank
graphic, you must specify the name and location of the graphic file.
Refer to “Saving a Custom Graphic to a New Location or File Name”
below.
To save a graphic:
◆ On the Graphics editor toolbar, click Save (see Figure 371). The
graphic file is updated with your changes.
BMTX-SVP01A-EN 439
Using the Graphics Editor
440 BMTX-SVP01A-EN
Saving Graphics
For example, the original standard graphic for an area is called area.htm
and is stored in the Graphics\Standard folder. Let’s say you open this
graphic and modify it, then use the Save Graphic command to save it.
Tracer Summit automatically saves the modified graphic to a file called
area.htm (the same name) in the Graphics\Custom folder. Now, when you
display the standard graphic for an area on any site, Tracer Summit dis-
plays the modified version of the graphic because it looks in the Graph-
ics\Custom folder before it looks in the Graphics\Standard folder.
To save a modified standard graphic in the Graphics\site name folder,
you need to use the Save Graphic As command (as described in the next
section).
BMTX-SVP01A-EN 441
Using the Graphics Editor
• If you select Site Graphics, you must also identify the particular
site to which you want to assign this graphic. This graphic then
cannot be used for any other site.
4. To change the security access for this graphic, click the Security
Classes button to display the Change Security Classes dialog box.
5. At the Save As Graphic dialog box, click OK to save the graphic object
in the location you specified. (Do not check the Fill in Template Fields
check box.)
442 BMTX-SVP01A-EN
Restoring an Original Standard Graphic
Note:
When you save a graphic that contains template fields, the
graphic is not included on the navigation tree. See “Creating
and Modifying Graphics with Template Fields” on page 454 for
more information about template fields.
BMTX-SVP01A-EN 443
Using the Graphics Editor
Note:
You can also rename the HTML file, which has the same effect
as deleting the file because Tracer Summit will not be able to
locate it. You should rename a graphic file when you are not
sure whether you may need the custom graphic again in the
future.
444 BMTX-SVP01A-EN
About Site and Global Graphics
BMTX-SVP01A-EN 445
Using the Graphics Editor
446 BMTX-SVP01A-EN
Creating a Custom Graphic from a Blank Graphic
BMTX-SVP01A-EN 447
Using the Graphics Editor
To create a custom graphic from a blank graphic, you must open the
blank graphic, build the custom graphic, then save it.
3. Click New to display a blank graphic in the Graphics editor (see Fig-
ure 375 on page 449).
448 BMTX-SVP01A-EN
Creating a Custom Graphic from a Blank Graphic
BMTX-SVP01A-EN 449
Using the Graphics Editor
Note:
This is the only image a grid displays over.
4. Make a selection:
• To create an image that keeps its proportion (or aspect ratio) the
same as you created it, click once on the graphic at the approxi-
mate place you want to insert the image.
• To create an image of a specific size, drag the insert cursor to cre-
ate a box where you will insert the image. Choosing this option
may distort the image’s aspect ratio (the image, for example, may
be stretched wider than it was when you created it). This may
adversely affect the quality of the image.
When you release the mouse button, the Image dialog box displays
(see Figure 378).
450 BMTX-SVP01A-EN
Creating a Custom Graphic from a Blank Graphic
5. Click Browse to select a file name and path of the image from the
Locate Image dialog box (see “Using the Locate Image Dialog Box” on
page 416).
6. At the Image dialog box, click OK. The graphic displays with the new
image inserted.
7. Change the size or position of the image as necessary. Follow the
directions for moving or sizing fields (see “Moving a Graphic Field” on
page 435 or “Resizing a Graphic Field” on page 435).
Inserting Fields
The task of inserting and configuring fields on a new custom graphic is
the same as on an existing standard graphic (see “Inserting a Graphic
Field” on page 420).
BMTX-SVP01A-EN 451
Using the Graphics Editor
Note:
A graphic that has template fields cannot be an expanded message.
You can use the same steps for creating an expanded message whether
you are working with a new graphic or an existing graphic.
To create an expanded message:
1. Display the Graphics editor and make a selection:
• Open an existing graphic that you want to use as an expanded
message.
• Create a graphic to use as the expanded message. Include text
fields and images as appropriate. You can create a custom graphic
from a blank graphic or edit a standard graphic.
2. From the File menu, select Save Graphic As. If you are saving the
graphic for the first time, select Save Graphic. The Save As Graphic
dialog box displays (see Figure 379 on page 453).
452 BMTX-SVP01A-EN
Creating Expanded Messages
BMTX-SVP01A-EN 453
Using the Graphics Editor
Note:
Graphics that were on the tree and were modified to include
template fields will no longer appear on the navigation tree.
454 BMTX-SVP01A-EN
Creating and Modifying Graphics with Template Fields
BMTX-SVP01A-EN 455
Using the Graphics Editor
Note:
For the Property screen, the Object Name field is automatically
assigned a value of <default>. For the Context Object screen,
the Object Type and Object Name fields are assigned a value of
<default>.
456 BMTX-SVP01A-EN
Creating and Modifying Graphics with Template Fields
2. Click the Template Graphics check box. The list updates to include all
template graphics.
3. Click the name of the graphic, then click Edit. The selected graphic
displays in the Graphics editor.
4. Edit and save the graphic.
BMTX-SVP01A-EN 457
Using the Graphics Editor
3. Complete the Object Name and HTML File Name fields with different
names for standard graphic objects. (Overriding a standard graphic
object with permanent information for template fields will do so for
all objects that use the same standard graphic object.)
458 BMTX-SVP01A-EN
Deleting a Graphic
Deleting a Graphic
There are two steps to deleting a graphic:
• Deleting the graphic object
• Deleting the HTML file associated with it
To delete a graphic object:
Use the Delete Object utility on the Tools menu. See Chapter 37, “Delet-
ing Objects and Sites.”
To delete an HTML file associated with a file:
In Windows Explorer, use standard procedures to delete the associated
HTML file from the Graphics\site name folder or from Graphics\Custom
folder. When displaying the object, Tracer Summit will revert to the
graphic stored in the Graphics\Standard folder, if there is one. (If there is
no standard graphic file, the user will see an error message indicating
that the file does not exist or cannot be found.)
Note:
Renaming a graphic file to a name that is not called by Tracer
Summit has the same effect as deleting the HTML file. Tracer
Summit cannot find this file. Rename a graphic file only when
you are not sure whether you may need a custom graphic again
in the future.
BMTX-SVP01A-EN 459
Using the Graphics Editor
Historical Graphs
A historical graph shows values that have been stored by the BCU in a
trend object. Graphs that display trend objects are static since the data is
historical. Using a right-mouse-click, you can refresh the data, change the
style of the graph, or print it out.
460 BMTX-SVP01A-EN
Using the Graphing Control Editor
Note:
You are only allowed to add up to four properties to the tree.
Then the Add button is not available. Clicking on the plus (+)
sign, expands the list to show the selected graph properties.
BMTX-SVP01A-EN 461
Using the Graphics Editor
7. Repeat steps 2-6 above to add other properties to the list of members,
as necessary.
8. To remove properties from the Graph Members tree, highlight the
selection and click Remove.
9. To add a Trend member and select graph plot properties, see the fol-
lowing sections.
10. Click OK to create the graph and return to the Graphics editor’s main
screen, where the Graph field is displayed (see Figure 387 on
page 463).
To set the graph members for a single Trend object:
1. In the Site box, select the site name.
2. In the Type list box, select a Trend (see Figure 386).
462 BMTX-SVP01A-EN
Using the Graphing Control Editor
8. To select graph plot properties, see “To select graph plot properties:”
on page 463
9. Click OK to create the graph and return to the Graphics editor’s main
screen, where the Graph field is displayed (see Figure 387).
Note:
Y2 items will always be a line drawn on the graph, except for
Area (3D). In Area (3D), Y2 selections are graphed against the
Y1-axis.
Note:
All except the line graph can be viewed in two or three dimen-
sions.
BMTX-SVP01A-EN 463
Using the Graphics Editor
4. In the Background Color field, select the background color that the
graph title, plot, and time stamps will appear on.
5. In the Refresh Rate field, select the sampling rate for the graphed
properties. The selected and plotted properties are all sampled at this
rate. The time stamp appears in military time.
6. Click OK to save the information and return to the Graphics editor,
where the Graph field is displayed (see Figure 387 on page 463).
Note:
This tab can be accessed at any time in the runtime mode from
a pop-up menu item by right-clicking on the graph. This allows
you to quickly change graph types, while keeping the graphic
field open.
464 BMTX-SVP01A-EN
Using the Graphing Control Editor
BMTX-SVP01A-EN 465
Using the Graphics Editor
466 BMTX-SVP01A-EN
Chapter 28
BMTX-SVP01A-EN 467
Using the Trend Editor
468 BMTX-SVP01A-EN
Creating a New Trend
2. Click New. The New Trend Name dialog box displays (see
Figure 393).
3. In the Trend Name field, enter the name you want to give this trend.
The name can be up to 32 characters long.
BMTX-SVP01A-EN 469
Using the Trend Editor
4. Click OK. The Status screen of the Trend editor displays (see
Figure 394).
470 BMTX-SVP01A-EN
Setting the Members of a Trend
2. In the Type list box, select the object type for the object whose prop-
erty you want this trend to sample.
3. In the Name list box, select the name of the object whose property you
want this trend to sample.
4. In the Property list box, select the property you want this trend to
sample.
5. Click Add to add this property to the Member List box.
6. Repeat steps 2-5 above to add other properties to the list of members,
as necessary.
BMTX-SVP01A-EN 471
Using the Trend Editor
7. To remove a member from the Member List, select the member in the
Member List box, then click Remove to delete it from the list. Or, click
Remove All to clear the entire list.
Note:
Trend objects may contain up to 64 members. Because of BCU
memory limitations, however, the more members you include,
the fewer samples you can take. If taking large numbers of
samples is a priority for you, consider creating multiple Trend
objects with limited membership to accomplish this. You can
later combine the Trend objects in a single report for compari-
son. (See Table 24 on page 473 to understand the relationship
between number of members and number of possible samples.)
2. If you want to change the trend’s name, in the Trend Name field,
enter a new name for this trend.
3. In the Sampling Enable referencer edit control, select a method for
determining whether sampling should occur. Select Enabled to turn
on sampling manually. Select Disabled to turn off sampling manually.
472 BMTX-SVP01A-EN
Setting Up Trend Sampling
1 244
2 169
3 129
4 104
5 88
6 75
7 66
8 59
9 53
10 48
11 44
12 41
13 38
14 36
15 33
16 31
17 30
18 28
19 27
20 25
21 24
22 23
23 22
24 21
25–26 20
27 19
28–29 18
BMTX-SVP01A-EN 473
Using the Trend Editor
30–31 17
32–33 16
34–35 15
36–38 14
39–41 13
42–44 12
45–48 11
49–53 10
54–59 9
60–64 8
6. In the Interval field, select the frequency with which you want the
members to be sampled. You can choose 1 Minute, 5 Minutes, 15 Min-
utes, 1 Hour, 8 Hours, 1 Day, 7 Days, or Billing Period.
7. If you selected 8 Hours or 1 Day in the Interval field, the Collect Sam-
ple at Time field displays. Enter in this field the time of day you want
sampling to begin.
8. If you selected 7 Days in the Interval field, the Collect Sample at
Time field and the Collect Sample on Day field are displayed. Com-
plete these fields with the time of day you want sampling to begin,
and the day of the week you want sampling to begin, respectively.
9. If you selected Billing Period in the Interval field, the following but-
tons are displayed:
• Use Last Day of Month, which directs the system to sample at
11:59 p.m. on the last day of every month.
• Define Day of Month, which directs the system to sample at 11:59
p.m. on the day of the month you specify in the related field.
• Use Billing Periods.
The last button is available only if you have set up billing periods in
Site Configuration. You can select to sample at the end of any one of
up to three billing periods, which you specify in the related field.
474 BMTX-SVP01A-EN
Setting Security Access for a Trend
2. If you wish to use the Snapshot Trends feature, click Enable Snap-
shot. When a snapshot is taken, sampling is disabled until the snap-
shot is reset. This allows you to analyze the data leading up to the
point in time when the snapshot occurred.
3. If you selected Enable Snapshot, the Trigger On referencer edit con-
trol becomes active. In this field, specify the binary input referencer
or event state of an analog input object that serves as a trigger for a
snapshot to be taken. If you reference a binary property, that property
is monitored every minute, and if the state transitions from 0 to 1 for
more than two minutes, a snapshot is triggered.
If you reference the event state of an analog input object, that prop-
erty is monitored every minute. If the analog input object goes into a
Low Alarm or High Alarm for more than two minutes, a snapshot is
triggered (make sure the analog input object is not in an alarm state
when you initially assign the referencer). If you don’t make a selection
here, no snapshot is taken.
4. If you selected Enable Snapshot, the Snapshot Notification Class field
becomes active. In this field, specify which Event Class will receive a
message of the snapshot occurrence when a snapshot actually hap-
pens.
5. Click Security Classes to display the Change Security Classes dialog
box (see Figure 398 on page 476).
BMTX-SVP01A-EN 475
Using the Trend Editor
6. For each security class, click to insert a check mark if you want users
of this class to have security access to this trend object.
7. Click OK to return to the Classes screen.
476 BMTX-SVP01A-EN
Saving a Trend Object to a BCU
BMTX-SVP01A-EN 477
Using the Trend Editor
478 BMTX-SVP01A-EN
Chapter 29
BMTX-SVP01A-EN 479
Using the Calculations Editor
Average
The Average calculation returns the average value for the current day
and the current billing period.
Today’s Avg = A / N
A = Running total
N = Counter for number of samples
Today’s Avg = New Average
Processing: Once per minute. If the enable referencer is on, the refer-
enced analog value is added to the running total (A), and the counter (N)
is incremented. The running total (A) is divided by the counter (N) to
obtain the average. Calculated values are saved for the current and previ-
ous day, and for the current and previous billing period.
480 BMTX-SVP01A-EN
About Calculation Types
Note:
The Cool Flow Rate calculation requires a conversion factor to
scale the flow measurement device and account for the heat
content of the fluid. If the calculation is for a constant volume
process, you must assign an analog output with a default value
of the volume for the Flow Rate referencer.
Temp 1 = 4
BMTX-SVP01A-EN 481
Using the Calculations Editor
Note:
The Heat Flow Rate calculation requires a conversion factor to
scale the flow measurement device and account for the heat
content of the fluid. If the calculation is for a constant volume
process, you should assign an analog output with a default
value of the volume for the Flow Rate referencer.
Temp 1 = 4
For a boiler:
Temp 2 = 1
Temp 1 = 2 Return Boiler Supply
Hot Water 1 2 Hot Water
482 BMTX-SVP01A-EN
About Calculation Types
Maximum
The Maximum calculation returns the highest value for the current day
and current billing period.
Processing: If the enable referencer is on, the current analog value is
compared to the present maximum value. If the current analog value is
greater than the present maximum value, then the current analog value
is saved as the new maximum value. Calculated values are saved for the
current and previous day, and for the current and previous billing period.
Note:
If the current analog value is equal to the present maximum
value, the current value is not saved as the new maximum
value.
Minimum
The Minimum calculation returns the lowest values that have occurred
during the current day and current billing period.
Processing: If the enable referencer is on, the current analog value is
compared to the present minimum value. If the current analog value is
less than the present minimum value, the current analog value is saved
as the new minimum value. Calculated values are saved for the current
and previous day, and for the current and previous billing period.
Note:
If the current analog value is equal to the present minimum
value, the current value is not saved as the new minimum
value.
Meter Totalization
The Meter Totalization calculation totals metered flow rates, such as gas,
electric, and water.
Total = Total + (Meter Value x Conv)
BMTX-SVP01A-EN 483
Using the Calculations Editor
lated values are saved for the current and previous day and the current
and previous billing period.
Note:
To set up this calculation, you must connect a metered input
(pulse or analog) to a BCU I/O Module, PCM, UPCM, or
MP580/581. You need to know the operating specifics, such as
type or scaling for the selected meter, to determine the appro-
priate conversion factor (Conv). A typical pulse meter input, for
example, is attached to a PCM binary input and configured to
measure electrical usage in KW. This rate (in KW) is stored in
the PCM object as a Pulse Accumulator property and is refer-
enced by the Meter Totalization calculation object. To total this
in KW, the conversion factor is 0.01667, or KW/60 samples per
hour.
484 BMTX-SVP01A-EN
About Calculation Types
ics the logic that electrical utilities use to bill customers for electrical
usage over a shifting time frame.
Note:
Electrical meters are typically pulse meters. If brought into a
PCM, UPCM, or MP580/581, the controller can calculate a
KWH rate that the calculation object can reference.
BMTX-SVP01A-EN 485
Using the Calculations Editor
486 BMTX-SVP01A-EN
About Calculation Types
N = Number of Starts
T = Total Number of Run Hours
Processing for Starts: If the enable referencer is on and the binary ref-
erencer transitions from Off to On, the number of starts (N) is incre-
mented. Calculated values are saved for the current and previous day,
and for the current and previous billing period.
Processing for Run Hours: If the enable referencer is on and the prop-
erty referencer is on, the total number of run hours (T) is incremented.
Calculated values are saved for the current and previous day, and for the
current and previous billing period.
Typical Application 1: Run hours and starts typically determine equip-
ment maintenance schedule.
Note:
For typical application 1, you should not clear run hour and
start calculations at the end of the billing period. These calcula-
tions typically reference an analog input, which generates an
alarm when a defined run hour limit or starts limit has been
exceeded. For example, a chiller might be set to generate an
alarm when it has run for 100 hours, or when it has more than
200 starts.
BMTX-SVP01A-EN 487
Using the Calculations Editor
488 BMTX-SVP01A-EN
Creating a New Calculation Object
Note:
You must enter a name before you can save the new calculation
object. You can modify the name from the Setup screen of the
Calculations editor.
4. Click OK. The Select Calculation Type dialog box displays (see
Figure 402 on page 490).
BMTX-SVP01A-EN 489
Using the Calculations Editor
490 BMTX-SVP01A-EN
Setting Up a Calculation Object
2. For each referencer field, click the referencer button (...) to the right of
the field. The Select Property Reference dialog box displays (see Fig-
ure 404 on page 492).
BMTX-SVP01A-EN 491
Using the Calculations Editor
492 BMTX-SVP01A-EN
Clearing Calculation Data
3. Click the check box next to the quantities you want to clear.
4. Click OK to save and reset the quantities to 0.000.
Note:
Clearing of data occurs the next time the calculation is run.
This may occur as much as one minute following the clearing of
data.
BMTX-SVP01A-EN 493
Using the Calculations Editor
2. Click Security Classes. The Change Security Classes dialog box dis-
plays (see Figure 407).
3. Click the Access field next to each class to grant or deny access. A
check in the field grants access. No check denies access.
4. Click OK to display the Classes screen.
5. Click Save.
494 BMTX-SVP01A-EN
Chapter 30
Designing Reports
The ability to create reports that are tailored to your facility is a key ben-
efit of the Tracer Summit system. Reports provide the information you
need to make decisions about building operations. Reports help you man-
age utility costs, equipment efficiency, and tenant billings.
The Report editor allows you to design easy-to-run, easy-to-read reports.
You can use any information available in Tracer Summit to create a
report. You can define report elements such as titles, footers, fonts, and
page orientation. You can also instruct the system to automatically gener-
ate custom reports at regular intervals. Automatically generated reports
can be printed and stored to disk for data archiving.
Use reports for:
• Record keeping and documentation
• Energy monitoring
• Troubleshooting
You run reports using the Reports Viewer, which is accessed from the Sta-
tus menu or from the Reports button on the toolbar. For instructions on
running reports, refer to the Tracer Summit Daily Operations guide.
Note:
For Tracer 100 sites, you can only use the Reports Viewer to see
the Diagnostic Report for the site. You cannot use the Reports
editor to create a report. Tracker sites do not have reports to
view or edit.
BMTX-SVP01A-EN 495
Designing Reports
Report Types
Tracer Summit supports two types of reports—live and trend.
• Live Reports. Live reports display selected values at a particular
point in time (see Figure 408 on page 497).
• Trend Reports. Trend reports use trend objects to display historical
data obtained over a period of time (see Figure 409 on page 498).
Live Reports
Live reports display values of selected properties at the time the report is
run. Each line in a live report contains a row heading, followed by the cur-
rent value(s) for the property. A live report can display three types of
members:
• Any single displayable property in the system
• A calculation object with predefined properties
• A blank row
When a calculation object is used in a live report, the report displays data
based on the calculation type it is performing. The current value, today’s
value, yesterday’s value, current billing period’s value, and last billing
period’s value are displayed on the same row. See Figure 408 on page 497.
496 BMTX-SVP01A-EN
Live Reports
BMTX-SVP01A-EN 497
Designing Reports
Trend Reports
Trend reports allow you to view, print, and save the historical data col-
lected in trend objects (see Figure 409). For information about setting up
a trend object, see Chapter 28, “Using the Trend Editor”.
A trend report can display data collected over multiple time periods, such
as a trend of space temperatures and relative humidity. It can also dis-
play multiple properties over the same time period, such as a 12-month
chiller summary report. A custom trend report may contain information
from multiple trend objects, even at different intervals.
A trend report displays the date and time in the left column, and values
from the selected trends in subsequent columns. You can use as many
trend members as you would like in a report. If a sample does not exist for
an object and property for a given time, the data cell is blank. For exam-
ple, a custom report contains a trend object with a five-minute interval,
and a trend object with a 30-minute interval. The trend object with the
five-minute interval displays data for each five-minute interval. The
trend object with the 30-minute interval displays data only at half-hour
intervals. The rows that contain five-minute intervals contain blank
areas. If a trend sample was unable to be collected, the report will display
“???”.
498 BMTX-SVP01A-EN
Running a Report
Standard Reports
Tracer Summit includes a set of predefined standard live and standard
trend reports.
Standard live reports provide status information for a single object. Most
objects in the system have at least one associated standard live report.
You can create your own standard live reports. You can also edit pre-
defined standard live reports.
Standard trend reports (known as quick trend reports in previous ver-
sions of Tracer Summit) display a pre-formatted trend report containing
all the trend members in a trend object. Standard trend objects cannot be
edited. You can, however, create your own custom trend reports.
Running a Report
You run a report using the Report Viewer, which you can access by click-
ing the Reports button on the toolbar or selecting Reports from the Status
menu. You can also run a standard report from a UCM or application edi-
tor by clicking the Report button on the editor’s Status screen.
After you run the report, you can print it, saved it to a Report (.rpt) file, or
export it to a tab delimited text file (.TXT). For more information about
running a report, see the Tracer Summit Daily Operations guide.
Note:
For Tracer 100 sites, you can only use the Reports Viewer to see
the Diagnostic Report for the site. You cannot use the Reports
editor to create a report. Tracker sites do not have reports to
view or edit.
Note:
For Tracer 100 sites, you can only use the Reports Viewer to see
the Diagnostic Report for the site. You cannot use the Reports
editor to create a report. Tracker sites do not have reports to
view or edit.
BMTX-SVP01A-EN 499
Designing Reports
Note:
If you need help with reports, click the Tutorial button to open
the Tracer Summit Daily Operations Tutorial.
4. Click the arrow to the right of the Standard Report Type field to
select a report type. The available reports that match the selected
type appear in the Report Name list.
5. In the Units field, select the units of measure (either Inch-Pound or
International System) for the report. The default selection is the units
of measure defined for the site in site configuration.
6. If you wish to open a blank report containing default selections, click
New to display the Report editor.
500 BMTX-SVP01A-EN
Accessing the Report Editor
BMTX-SVP01A-EN 501
Designing Reports
2. Enter a name for the report in the Report Name field. Make the name
as informative as possible. Use a maximum of 32 alphanumeric char-
acters.
3. Choose the report’s page orientation (portrait or landscape).
502 BMTX-SVP01A-EN
Defining Report Members
Note:
There are a few membership rules unique to the standard live
report type. When you run a standard live report, you should
understand these rules:
• Standard live reports may contain properties from a single
object type.
• If a new report is created, the Type field will be available
until the first report member is defined.
• Subsequent report members must be the same object type.
BMTX-SVP01A-EN 503
Designing Reports
2. Click the object type in the Type list. Available objects of the selected
type are displayed in the Name list.
3. Click the object name in the Name list. Available properties of the
selected object are displayed in the Property list.
4. Click the name of the property in the Property list.
5. Click Add to add your selection to the Report Members list.
6. With the member you just added highlighted in the Report Members
list, enter the label you want the report to display for that member in
the Row Heading field. You can enter one or two row headings.
7. Continue to define the report members, repeating steps 2 through 6
for each member.
504 BMTX-SVP01A-EN
Defining Report Members
2. Click the name of the trend in the Trend list. Available Trend mem-
bers for the selected trend are displayed in the Trend Members list.
3. Click the name of the member in the Trend Members list.
4. Click Add to add your selection to the Report Members list.
5. With the member you just added highlighted in the Report Members
list, enter the label you want the report to display for that member in
the Column Heading field. You can enter one or two column headings.
6. Continue to define the report members, repeating steps 2 through 5
for each member.
BMTX-SVP01A-EN 505
Designing Reports
Table 25. Entering Date, Page, Time, and Security Functions in a Report
506 BMTX-SVP01A-EN
Entering Titles and Formatting the Report
selections will appear in the Layout screen. To change the existing set-
tings, select the cell contents and enter a new entry.
To set the page orientation (portrait or landscape) of the report, refer to
“Editing the Name or Orientation of the Report” on page 502.
2. Click the desired cells in the Header section and enter the titles you
want to display in the report.
3. To change the font for a cell, select the cell and click the Font button
to the right of the Header section. The Font dialog box displays.
4. Select the font, font styles, and size.
5. Click OK to close the Font dialog box and display the Layout screen.
Note:
Column headings 2 through 5—which are Today, Yesterday,
Last billing period, and Current billing period—only appear in
a custom live report that contains calculation report members.
BMTX-SVP01A-EN 507
Designing Reports
3. To change the font for a cell, select the cell and click the Font button
to the right of the Column Headings section. The Font dialog box dis-
plays.
4. Select the font, font style, and size.
5. Click OK to close the Font dialog box and display the Layout screen.
Scheduling a Report
Tracer Summit allows you to instruct the system to run custom live and
custom trend reports automatically at specific times. You can schedule a
report to run daily, weekly, monthly, or annually. You schedule a report in
the Schedule screen of the Report editor.
508 BMTX-SVP01A-EN
Scheduling a Report
2. Click the arrows to the right of the Time 1 field to set a time for the
first daily report.
3. If you want to schedule times for more than one daily report, check
the associated check box and set a time in the Time 2, Time 3, and/or
Time 4 fields.
2. Click the arrows to the right of the Time field to set a time for the
weekly report.
BMTX-SVP01A-EN 509
Designing Reports
3. Click the arrow to the right of the Day field to set a day for the weekly
report.
510 BMTX-SVP01A-EN
Scheduling a Report
2. Click the arrows to the right of the Month field to set a month for the
annual report.
3. Click the arrow to the right of the Day of Month field to set a day for
the annual report.
4. Click the arrow to the right of the Time field to set a time for the
annual report.
BMTX-SVP01A-EN 511
Designing Reports
512 BMTX-SVP01A-EN
Saving the Report
Deleting Reports
Occasionally, you may want to delete reports from the Tracer Summit sys-
tem. For example, you may want to delete specific reports you created for
site setup and troubleshooting.
Note:
After you delete reports from the system, you cannot recover
them unless you have a report backup file. Before deleting
reports, we recommend backing up all reports that you may
want to use again. See the Tracer Summit Daily Operations
Guide for information on backing up reports, or see Chapter 36,
“Restoring into the Tracer Summit Workstation”, of this guide
for information on restoring reports.
To delete reports:
1. Display the Report editor (see “Accessing the Report Editor” on
page 499).
2. From the File menu, select Delete Reports. The Delete Reports -
Select Site dialog box displays.
3. Select the site that contains the report you want to delete and click
OK. The Delete Reports dialog box displays.
4. In the Type field, select the type of the report you want to delete. You
can delete custom reports or user-defined standard reports. (Pre-
defined standard reports included with Tracer Summit may be edited,
but cannot be deleted.)
5. In the Existing Reports list, select the report names you want to
delete.
BMTX-SVP01A-EN 513
Designing Reports
6. Click the Add button. The reports display in the Selected Reports to
Delete list. You can also click Add All to add all reports of the selected
type to the list of reports to delete.
7. To remove any reports from the Selected Reports to Delete list, select
the report name and click Remove. You can also click Remove All to
clear the list.
8. Click the Delete button. You are prompted to confirm the deletion.
9. Click Yes. The selected reports are deleted.
514 BMTX-SVP01A-EN
Chapter 31
The System Options editor allows you to customize or change screen, file,
and print options to fit your preferences. The selected options affect only
the PC Workstation you are working on. Event log capacity settings, how-
ever, might affect the performance of multiple workstations in a shared
database.
The System Options editor allows you to
• Select the home graphic, which is the screen that displays when you
click Home
• Select the event log printer and alarm options
• Change the default file directories
• Change the workstation device ID for event routing
• Select whether object and property IDs are displayed throughout the
Tracer Summit system
• Set up basic e-mail message forwarding services
• Configure connection options for the navigation tree
• Change e-mail profile
BMTX-SVP01A-EN 515
Setting System Options
516 BMTX-SVP01A-EN
Setting Up the Events Printer, Message Forwarding, and Event Log Settings
2. Click Change to the right of the Home Graphic field to display the
Select Home Graphic dialog box (see Figure 425).
3. In the Graphic Object Name list, click the name of the graphic you
wish to select.
Note:
The Select Home Graphic dialog box lists all available system
graphics stored in the C:\Program Files\Tracer
Summit\Graphics\Custom directory.
BMTX-SVP01A-EN 517
Setting System Options
2. To change the events printer, in the Events group click Change. The
Print Setup dialog box displays (see Figure 427 on page 519).
Note:
The Print Setup dialog box varies depending upon the printer
selected.
518 BMTX-SVP01A-EN
Setting Up the Events Printer, Message Forwarding, and Event Log Settings
3. In the Name field, select the printer that Tracer Summit will use to
print events and alarms.
Note:
• Tracer Summit sends alarm and event information to the
printer one line at a time. A tractor-feed (or line-feed)
printer works best as the events printer so that you can
view the events as they are generated and printed. If you
select a sheet-feed printer (such as a laser printer), you do
not see the events until a complete page is printed.
• Typically, the events printer is connected directly to the PC
Workstation (on the LPT1: port).
IMPORTANT
Selecting Disable Workstation Alarm keeps the workstation from beep-
ing when an alarm comes in, regardless of how Alarm and Message
Routing is setup.
BMTX-SVP01A-EN 519
Setting System Options
IMPORTANT
Your workstation must be set up as an event receiver in BCU sites, with
a telephone number defined in Tracer 100 and Tracker sites, and other
requirements for alarms must be satisfied, as described in Chapter 6,
“Configuring Tracer Summit BCU Sites.”
Note:
If you set the refresh rate value too low, the user may experi-
ence what appear to be screen lockups.
520 BMTX-SVP01A-EN
Setting Up the Events Printer, Message Forwarding, and Event Log Settings
Note:
• The BCU event log and the error log viewers cannot be
automatically refreshed. Selecting Enable Auto Refresh has
no effect on these viewers.
• In a shared SQL database, workstations do not share this
setting. Each workstation has its own setting.
• If you change the database source from SQL to an existing
Microsoft Access Tracer Summit database, the refresh rate
is restored to its previous value. However, when you change
the database source from SQL to a blank Microsoft Access
Tracer Summit database, the refresh rate is reset to its
default Microsoft Access value when Tracer Summit starts
up.
3. Select the event log capacity from the Event Log Capacity list.
For system performance and manageability, you can modify the stor-
age capacity of the event log with your selection of the Event Log
Capacity. The Tracer Summit software will not allow the number of
events saved in the database to exceed this limit.
If you do insert a new event in the database that exceeds this limit,
the Tracer Summit software deletes the oldest events in the database
until the number of events in the database comes within the limit.
The type of database that you are using determines the maximum
limits
Note:
• If the new event log capacity value is less than the number
of existing events in the log, the following warning message
appears: You will lose events from your Event Log! It is rec-
ommended that you cancel and first back up the Event Log.
Continue with save and lose events? <Yes> <No>.
• If you click Yes, the new capacity value is saved, and
the log is truncated to the new value when a new event
is inserted in the log.
• If you click No, changes are not saved, and the capacity
is restored to the original value.
• In a shared SQL database, workstations share this setting.
Each workstation cannot have its own setting because the
database is shared.
• If you change the database source from SQL to an existing
Microsoft Access Tracer Summit database, the event log
capacity value is restored to its previous value. However,
when you change the database source from SQL to a blank
Microsoft Access Tracer Summit database, the event log
capacity value is reset to its default Microsoft Access value
when Tracer Summit starts up.
BMTX-SVP01A-EN 521
Setting System Options
4. From the BCU Event Log Capacity list, select the record size and
change it to the appropriate value.
When the new value is less than the number of existing records in the
log, a warning appears, as described in the note for step 3.
5. From the Error Log Capacity list, select the record size and change it
to the appropriate value.
When the new value is less than the number of existing records in the
log, a warning appears, as described in the note for step 3.
6. Click Save.
522 BMTX-SVP01A-EN
Changing Default File Directories
IMPORTANT
When you are using a shared SQL database, you might have to store
these files in a shared folder on your LAN. This is to ensure that all
Tracer Summit users can access these files.
3. Click the file type whose location you wish to modify in the File Types
list.
4. Click Modify to display the Browse for Folder dialog box (see Figure
431 on page 524).
BMTX-SVP01A-EN 523
Setting System Options
Note:
Tracer Summit provides a default workstation device ID that is
based on the number assigned during the software installation.
Generally, the first workstation created is ID 80. Each addi-
tional workstation number is increased in increments of one.
Typical workstation addressing is as follows:
• 80 – 100 for on-site workstations
• 101 – 120 for remote workstations
• 121 – 140 Trane-reserved addressing
524 BMTX-SVP01A-EN
Changing Advanced Settings
BMTX-SVP01A-EN 525
Setting System Options
526 BMTX-SVP01A-EN
Changing Advanced Settings
2. Select a profile. The Username and Password fields of the mailbox are
blank.
3. If required, type the correct username and password to access the
mailbox of the profile on the server. The password displays as a series
of asterisks (see Figure 436).
IMPORTANT
If no profiles display, contact your IS or system administrator for help in
creating a new e-mail profile for your PC.
BMTX-SVP01A-EN 527
Setting System Options
528 BMTX-SVP01A-EN
Chapter 32
The BCU operator display is a liquid crystal display (LCD) touch screen
that is installed in Tracer Summit BMTX or BMTW BCU as an option.
The operator display makes it possible for the occasional daily user to
perform most of the Tracer Summit daily activities at the BCU.
Initially, the Tracer Summit software and PC Workstation are needed to
set up the operator display for operations. After setup is complete, the
operator display can serve as a stand-alone operator interface between
the user and the building automation system (BAS) equipment.
At the PC Workstation, the following site objects are set up for monitoring
at the BCU operator display:
• Equipment and applications
• Time of day schedules
• Alarms and events
For information on using the operator display, see the Tracer Summit
BCU Operator Display Operations guide.
BMTX-SVP01A-EN 529
The BCU Operator Display
3. Click OK to display the Operator Display editor (see Figure 438). The
editor opens up to the Status tab. View this screen to see the number
of objects that has been selected for monitoring at the operator dis-
play.
530 BMTX-SVP01A-EN
Creating a New BCU Operator Display
Note:
The operator display buttons are only available for BMTX and
BMTW BCUs.
BMTX-SVP01A-EN 531
The BCU Operator Display
• If the appropriate BCU is listed, select it. Then click the Edit
Device button. The Edit Device dialog box displays (see
Figure 440).
• If the appropriate BCU is not listed, click the Create Device but-
ton to display the Create Device screen.
3. Click the Operator Display Add button. The Create New Operator
Display dialog box displays (see Figure 441).
532 BMTX-SVP01A-EN
Creating a New BCU Operator Display
4. Type a name in the Operator Display Name field. Make the name as
informative as possible. Use a maximum of 32 characters.
Note:
You must enter a name before you can save the new operator
display object. You can modify the name at any time from the
Edit Operator Display dialog box. You can access the dialog box
from the Operator Display Edit button.
5. To change the default security access for the operator display, click
Security Classes (see “Setting Up Security for the Operator Display”
on page 158).
6. Click OK to close the Create New Operator Display dialog box.
7. From the Edit Device screen, click OK.
8. From the Devices screen, click Save. The operator display object is not
created until you save.
9. Click OK to return to the main screen.
BMTX-SVP01A-EN 533
The BCU Operator Display
Selecting a Device
From the Devices screen, you can quickly select all of the objects residing
in a device. The objects will then be available at the operator display for
monitoring.
1. From the Operator Display editor, click the Devices tab. The Devices
Screen displays (see Figure 442).
534 BMTX-SVP01A-EN
Setting Up the BCU Operator Display
2. From the Available Devices list, select the name of the device.
3. Click the Add button to add the device to the Selected Devices list.
Note:
The Tracer Summit software automatically moves all the object
types in that device to the Selected Objects list on the Object
Types screen (see Figure 443 on page 536). Also, the members
associated with those object types are automatically moved to
the Selected Objects list on the Members screen (see Figure 444
on page 537).
Removing a Device
1. From the Selected Devices list, select the name of the device.
2. Click the Remove button to move the device back to the Available
Devices window.
Note:
The Tracer Summit software automatically moves all the object
types in that device back to the Available Objects list on the
Object Types tab. Also, the members associated with those
object types are automatically moved back to the Available
Objects list on the Members tab. All of the objects for that
device will no longer be available at the operator display for
monitoring.
BMTX-SVP01A-EN 535
The BCU Operator Display
2. From the Available Object Types list, select the name of the object.
3. Click the Add button to add the object to the Selected Object Types
list.
Note:
When you select objects from the Available Object Types list,
the Tracer Summit software automatically moves all of the
members belonging to that object type from the Available
Object list to the Selected Objects list on the Members screen
(see Figure 444 on page 537). Also, the software automatically
moves the associated device from the Available Devices list to
the Selected Devices list on the Devices screen (see Figure 442
on page 534).
536 BMTX-SVP01A-EN
Setting Up the BCU Operator Display
Note:
The Tracer Summit software automatically moves all of the
members belonging to that object type from the Selected
Objects list to the Available Objects list on the Members tab.
The members of the object type will no longer be available for
monitoring at the operator display.
Selecting Members
Use this screen to quickly select and remove members of an object type
from the object lists.
To select members of an object type:
1. From the Operator Display editor, click the Members tab. The Mem-
bers screen displays (see Figure 444).
2. From the Available Objects list, select the name of the member.
BMTX-SVP01A-EN 537
The BCU Operator Display
3. Click the Add button to add the member to the Selected Objects list.
Note:
When you select objects from the Available Objects list, the
Tracer Summit software automatically moves the object type
associated with that member from the Available Object Types
list to the Selected Object Types list on the Object Types screen
(see Figure 443 on page 536). Also, the software automatically
moves the associated device from the Available Devices list to
the Selected Devices list on the Devices screen (Figure 442 on
page 534).
Removing Members
1. In the Selected Objects list, select the name of the member you want
to remove.
2. Click the Remove button to move the member back to the Available
Objects list. That member will no longer be available for monitoring
at the operator display.
Note:
If you remove all of the members belonging to an object type,
the Tracer Summit software will automatically move the object
type back to the Available Object Types list on the Object Types
tab. The members of that object type will no longer be available
for monitoring at the operator display.
538 BMTX-SVP01A-EN
Customizing the Operator Display Home Screen
BMTX-SVP01A-EN 539
The BCU Operator Display
Title
Description of Custom
data point #1
Custom data
points
Description of Custom
data point #2
540 BMTX-SVP01A-EN
Setup Options for the Operator Display
BMTX-SVP01A-EN 541
The BCU Operator Display
4. Click the Enable Security checkbox to place a check in the box (see
Figure 448).
Note:
The software will automatically place a check in this box when
an operator display password is assigned in the Site Security
editor (see “Setting Up Security for the Operator Display” on
page 158).
542 BMTX-SVP01A-EN
Setup Options for the Operator Display
BMTX-SVP01A-EN 543
The BCU Operator Display
Note:
When the quick-select function is disabled (checkbox not
checked), only the application will be moved in the operator dis-
play object list.
544 BMTX-SVP01A-EN
Setup Options for the Operator Display
Note:
Only custom screens that have not been saved (an asterisk
appears after the name) are moved back to the Available
Screens list.
BMTX-SVP01A-EN 545
The BCU Operator Display
546 BMTX-SVP01A-EN
Chapter 33
The BCU Custom Screen editor enables you to create custom screens that
you can download to a BCU operator display. Using the Custom Screen
editor, you can develop screens that meet the unique needs of users and
sites.
Situations when you might create custom screens include those where
different levels of users access the operator display during daily opera-
tions. For example, at a site where the users are not advanced, you can
create a screen that fits their needs and uses. For sites where more
advanced users access the operator display, you can create more sophisti-
cated screens than the standard screens.
Custom screens often provide quick access to frequently used informa-
tion, as well as to information that is not available on standard operator
display screens. With custom screens, for example, you can insert a
graphic of your equipment and then apply graphic and text fields that
report the status of the equipment and let you perform overrides.
With custom screens, you can:
• Create a library of custom screens and navigation schemes that can
be used at multiple job sites
• Use a combination of custom and standard screens in the BCU opera-
tor display
• Navigate from a custom screen to a standard screen
• Create a monochrome bitmap unique to your site and import it and
display it
• Define custom reports to display
• Define which object/properties that you can view on text and graphic
screens
Creating custom screens for the operator display uses procedures similar
to those for creating other Tracer Summit graphics. For more information
about creating Tracer Summit graphics in general, see “Using the Graph-
ics Editor Tools” on page 409.
BMTX-SVP01A-EN 547
Using the Custom Screen Editor
548 BMTX-SVP01A-EN
About Custom Screen Graphics
Bitmap image
Status text
Back Target
View equip-
Home Target ment Button
Target Button
Binary text
Imported custom bitmaps Override
button
BMTX-SVP01A-EN 549
Using the Custom Screen Editor
550 BMTX-SVP01A-EN
Creating Custom Screens
Figure 455. New Operator Display Custom Screen Name Dialog Box
5. From the BCU Name list, select the BCU operator display that you
are creating the custom screen for.
Note:
Tracer Summit only allows you to assign the screen to a BCU
that already has an operator display created for it.
BMTX-SVP01A-EN 551
Using the Custom Screen Editor
552 BMTX-SVP01A-EN
Using the Custom Screen Editor Tools
Cut, Copy, Paste, Delete Undo, Redo Align: Make Same: Center: Move Field Tools:
Top, Right, Top Height, Width, Horizontally, to Front or Snap to Grid,
or Bottom or Size Vertically Back Set X/Y Snap.
Screen Name
BMTX-SVP01A-EN 553
Using the Custom Screen Editor
554 BMTX-SVP01A-EN
Using the Custom Screen Editor Tools
Status text Inserts text drawn from the property you specify.
Status
Fields
Binary Inserts text drawn from the binary property you specify.
Override control Inserts a button that can override the present value for vari-
ous objects within a Tracer Summit site.
Control
Fields
Setpoint control Inserts a numeric text field. The field allows users to change
settings of numerical data.
Target Target button Inserts a button that links to another custom or standard
Fields screen.
Cursor Default cursor Changes the cursor from an insertion point back to a selec-
tion cursor.
BMTX-SVP01A-EN 555
Using the Custom Screen Editor
556 BMTX-SVP01A-EN
Using the Custom Screen Editor Tools
3. Scroll through the values in the Snap X Value list and/or click a new
value from the Snap Y Value list. The newly selected snap X value
and/or snap Y value displays in the corresponding fields of the dialog
box.
4. Click OK to redisplay the grid with the modified grid settings.
BMTX-SVP01A-EN 557
Using the Custom Screen Editor
2. Position the cursor at the location on the graphic where you want to
insert the field and click. The field is inserted and an editor that is
appropriate for that field displays.
From the dialog box, select the appropriate values as described in
“Selecting Property Reference and Setup Information for Status Text,
Binary Text, and Setpoint Control Fields” below.
558 BMTX-SVP01A-EN
Using the Custom Screen Editor Tools
• If you are entering binary text, type the text that will appear
when the apparatus is in an inactive and/or active state.
• If you are entering setpoint information, type the minimum and
maximum value.
Note:
Using this field you can restrict the acceptable range of values.
For instance, a valid zone temperature setpoint might be
between 50 and 90°F. However, for either energy-conservation
or comfort reasons, you might want to restrict the setpoint that
can be entered from the BCU operator display to a range of
65–85°F.
BMTX-SVP01A-EN 559
Using the Custom Screen Editor
Note:
During daily operations, the user can override this value at the
operator display.
Note:
The default is control class 12.
When you press the override button at the operator display, the prior-
ity of the override is evaluated to see whether it cancels the priority
that is currently controlling the property.
Use the names in the Available on System list as a reference when
assigning the current control class for the override control. The list
560 BMTX-SVP01A-EN
Using the Custom Screen Editor Tools
displays the 16 control class names that were set up in site configura-
tion (see “Setting Up Control Priorities” on page 578).
4. Click OK to insert the information on the custom screen.
3. Type the text that you want displayed on the custom screen.
4. Click OK to add the text to the custom screen. The static text string
displays on the custom screen.
BMTX-SVP01A-EN 561
Using the Custom Screen Editor
Override Control Field dialog box displays (see Figure 462 on page
560).
From the dialog box, select the appropriate values as described in
“Selecting a Bitmap” described below.
Selecting a Bitmap
1. Select the type of graphic you are entering:
• If you are inserting a custom bitmap that you have created and
saved in a directory, click the Custom button.
• If you are inserting a standard bitmap, click the Standard button.
562 BMTX-SVP01A-EN
Using the Custom Screen Editor Tools
1. From a custom screen, click the palette button associated with the
type of field you want to insert (see Table 27 on page 555). The cursor
turns into an insert prompt (see Figure 461 on page 558).
2. Position the cursor at the location on the screen where you want to
insert the field and click. The field is inserted and the Target Button
dialog box appears (see Figure 466).
BMTX-SVP01A-EN 563
Using the Custom Screen Editor
Note:
Remember that if you want to use the standard screens to view
all the equipment at your site, include a target button with the
Main View on one of your custom screens. If you do not include
this button, you will only be able to access the custom screens
you set up in the Operator Display editor as the first screen to
display (“Enabling Custom Screens” on page 543), as well as
the Home, Alarms, and Schedule screens.
3. If you are linking to a custom screen, from the Object Name/Type list,
select the type of object contained on the custom screen. Click None if
you are linking the target button to another custom screen that has
been developed for the site.
• Click the Object Name button to sort the Object/Name/Type by
the name of the object. The list orders the objects by alphanu-
meric name.
• Click the Type button to sort the Object Name/Type list by type of
object.
4. Click OK to insert the target button on the custom screen.
564 BMTX-SVP01A-EN
Organizing Custom Screen Fields
Note:
The custom screens are not added to the operator display until
you add them in the Operator Display editor and save them to
the database (“Selecting Custom Screens” on page 545).
BMTX-SVP01A-EN 565
Using the Custom Screen Editor
566 BMTX-SVP01A-EN
Editing Custom Screens
3. Select Edit Properties from the pop-up menu. The property dialog box
for the item appears.
• If you are editing a Status Text field, the Status Text property
dialog box appears.
• If you are editing a Binary Text field, the Binary Text property
dialog box appears.
• If you are editing an Override Control field, the Override Control
property dialog box appears (see “Defining the Properties of an
Override Control Field” on page 560).
• If you are editing a Setpoint Control field, the Setpoint Control
property dialog box appears.
• If you are editing a Static Text field, the Static Text property dia-
log box appears (see Figure 463 on page 561).
• If you are editing a Bitmap, the Bitmap property dialog box
appears (Figure 464 on page 562).
• If you are editing a Target Button, the Target Button property
dialog box appears (Figure 466 on page 563).
4. Change the properties as required.
5. From the File menu, select Save to store your changes in the data-
base.
BMTX-SVP01A-EN 567
Using the Custom Screen Editor
2. In the Screen name field, type the new name for the custom screen.
3. Click OK to change the name of the screen. The custom screen name
that appears beneath the custom screen template changes to the new
name.
568 BMTX-SVP01A-EN
Chapter 34
You can use the Rover Comm5 service tool within your Tracer Summit
software to configure unit controllers. There are two ways to do this:
• Start the full version of Rover from the Tracer Summit Tools menu
• Open Rover configuration screens from Tracer Summit UCM editors
You can use Rover to configure all supported Comm5 controllers through
Tracer Summit. The Rover Comm5 service tool must be purchased and
installed separately from Tracer Summit. Tracer Summit Version 15.0 or
higher and Rover Version 5.0 are required.
Note:
Rover Comm4, the Rover Flash Download application, and the
Air and Water Balancing application are not available through
Tracer Summit. All other Rover functions are available.
BMTX-SVP01A-EN 569
Using Rover in Tracer Summit
570 BMTX-SVP01A-EN
Setting up Security for Rover
BMTX-SVP01A-EN 571
Using Rover in Tracer Summit
Note:
An operator with full Rover access can configure all supported
Comm5 controllers, even if that operator does not have access
to certain types of Comm5 controllers in Tracer Summit.
572 BMTX-SVP01A-EN
Chapter 35
BMTX-SVP01A-EN 573
Using BACnet for Non-Trane Devices
574 BMTX-SVP01A-EN
Interfacing to Non-Trane BACnet Devices
6. Click the Devices tab to display the Devices screen (see Figure 477).
BMTX-SVP01A-EN 575
Using BACnet for Non-Trane Devices
8. Type the name and the device ID for the BACnet device.
Note:
The device ID is provided by the device manufacturer. Each
device on a network must have a unique device ID. Contact the
manufacturer for instructions, if necessary.
9. Select the object type from the Object Types field. The default selec-
tion is All Types.
10. Click the Scan button to display a list of all the available objects in
the non-Trane device.
11. From the Available Objects list, select the objects that you want to
view. Then, click the Add button to add the items to the Selected
Objects list.
12. Click Okay to save the changes and return to the Devices tab.
13. Click the Communications tab and check the Disable Automatic
Updates box (see Figure 479 on page 577).
576 BMTX-SVP01A-EN
Interfacing to Non-Trane BACnet Devices
Note:
By checking this box, Tracer Summit will no longer scan non-
Trane BACnet devices for updated objects every 30 minutes.
However, Tracer Summit will get updates from the non-Trane
devices when objects are viewed in custom graphics or Objects
and Properties.
Offline Editing
When editing offline, you can add an object to a non-Trane device using
the Manually Add New Objects fields.
To manually add new objects:
1. Type the object type, instance, and name of each object.
2. Click the Add button.
Note:
If you manually add an object with the same type and instance
of a device already in the Selected Objects list, the object will be
replaced with the new name that you manually gave the object.
BMTX-SVP01A-EN 577
Using BACnet for Non-Trane Devices
Note:
Be careful when modifying BACnet default applications. If you
are using BACnet protocols to communicate with non-Trane
devices, you must make sure the names align for each control
class.
578 BMTX-SVP01A-EN
Setting Up Control Priorities
3. Click the field to the right of the control class number you wish to
modify. The control class names that cannot be modified are unavail-
able.
4. When you are done making changes to the class names, click OK to
close the dialog box.
BMTX-SVP01A-EN 579
Using BACnet for Non-Trane Devices
580 BMTX-SVP01A-EN
Providing Information to Other Systems
BMTX-SVP01A-EN 581
Using BACnet for Non-Trane Devices
4. Click Create Device to display the Create New Device dialog box (see
Figure 484 on page 583).
582 BMTX-SVP01A-EN
Providing Information to Other Systems
5. Enter a name for the device in the Device Name field. Use up to 32
characters.
6. Type a number in the Device ID field.
Note:
All devices must have a unique device ID provided by the man-
ufacturer. Devices that share the same network must have
unique device numbers. Contact the device manufacturer for
instructions, if necessary.
Note:
Devices (BCUs and non-Trane devices) on a network must
share a network number. When you have multiple networks
(ARCNET, Ethernet, EIA-232) on a site, each network must
have a unique network number. For example, if you have a
BACnet interface using an EIA-232 connection between a BCU
and another vendor’s gateway, then the BCU must have a dif-
ferent network number than the other vendor’s gateway.
BMTX-SVP01A-EN 583
Using BACnet for Non-Trane Devices
8. From the Panel Type list box, select the device type: Enhanced BCU
(BMTX), modular BCU (BMTW) or BCU (BMTS). If the panel type is
a modular BCU (BMTW), the Capacity Cards field is available. For
high a capacity BCU, select 2. For a standard capacity BCU, select 1.
The BMTX has an on-board EIA-232 connection that does not require
configuration, skip the following steps for the BMTX.
10. Enter a name for the modem in the Modem Name field. Use up to 32
characters. Assign a name that will help you identify the modem,
such as BACnet Connection or EIA-232 Connection.
11. Click OK to return to the Edit Devices screen.
12. To add a BCU I/O module to the site, see Chapter 17, “BCU Inputs
and Outputs” for instructions.
Note:
The BCU I/O module buttons are only selectable for Modular
BCUs (BMTW)
584 BMTX-SVP01A-EN
Providing Information to Other Systems
3. Click the name of the modem you created for the EIA-232 Connection.
4. Click OK to display the Modem editor (see Figure 487).
5. Click the Setup tab to display the Setup screen (see Figure 488 on
page 586).
BMTX-SVP01A-EN 585
Using BACnet for Non-Trane Devices
6. Click the arrow to the right of the Connect By field to display a list of
modem types.
7. Select Hardwired.
Note:
As a BACnet input or output object is created, a BACnet ID is
automatically assigned to the object. Once you have created a
BACnet input or output object, do not delete the object. The
object address is only assigned once, and cannot be recreated
after it is deleted.
586 BMTX-SVP01A-EN
Running a Report of BACnet Objects
4. Click the arrow to the right of the Standard Report Type field to dis-
play a list of report types.
5. Click Site Reports to display a list of site reports in the Report Name
field.
6. Click Site BACnet Report.
7. Click OK to display the Sort Report By dialog box (see Figure 491 on
page 588).
BMTX-SVP01A-EN 587
Using BACnet for Non-Trane Devices
8. Click Device ID to sort the report by the device ID; click Name to sort
the report by the device name.
9. Click OK to display the Site BACnet Report in the Report Viewer (see
Figure 492).
10. To save the report in the default reports folder, click Save. For more
information on saving reports, refer to the Tracer Summit Daily Oper-
ations guide.
588 BMTX-SVP01A-EN
Running a Report of BACnet Objects
11. To print the report on a printer, click Print to display the Print dialog
box (see Figure 493).
12. Click OK to print the report. For instructions on changing the default
Print dialog box settings, see your Microsoft Windows or printer docu-
mentation.
Note:
Some manufacturers can input BACnet object data directly to
their system from an electronic file. You can use the Print to file
field in the Print dialog box to create an electronic file for this
purpose.
13. To print the report to a file, click the Print button in the Report
Viewer.
14. Click to select the Print to file check box.
15. Click OK to print to file. The print file will be saved in the default
report folder and will have a .PS file name extension.
16. Click Close to exit the Report Viewer.
BMTX-SVP01A-EN 589
Using BACnet for Non-Trane Devices
590 BMTX-SVP01A-EN
Chapter 36
After you have backed up site database files, Custom Programming Lan-
guage (CPL) files, graphics files and report files, you can restore these
files into the original PC workstation or a new PC workstation. For more
information on backing up Tracer Summit files, refer to the Tracer Sum-
mit Daily Operations guide.
Note:
If you need help restoring a site, click Tutorial to access The
Tracer Summit Operations Tutorial (tutorial button not
shown).
BMTX-SVP01A-EN 591
Restoring into the Tracer Summit Workstation
3. To change the Restore File Path, click Browse. The Select File to
Restore From dialog box displays (see Figure 495).
4. Select the directory where the site backup file is saved from the file
list. The file list displays previously saved backup files.
5. Select the file name to restore from the backup file list.
6. Click Open. The Site Restore dialog box displays again. The new file
name and path display in the Restore File Path field.
7. Select the specific site or sites to be restored from the Available
Site(s) list box.
8. Use Add or Add All to copy the selected sites to the Selected Sites
window. Click Remove or Remove All to remove the sites from the
Selected Sites window.
9. Click Next to display the Restore CPL dialog box (see Figure 496 on
page 593).
592 BMTX-SVP01A-EN
Restoring a Site and CPL Files
10. To change the source path for the CPL backup files, click Browse next
to the CPL Source Path field. The Browse for Folder dialog box dis-
plays.
11. Select a CPL source path from the selection window.
12. Click OK. The Restore CPL dialog box displays the selected CPL files.
13. To change the location to restore CPL files to, click Browse next to the
CPL Destination Path field. The Browse for Folder dialog box dis-
plays.
14. Select a CPL destination path.
15. Click OK. The Restore CPL dialog box displays.
16. Select the CPL file(s) to be restored from the Available CPL File(s)
list box.
17. Click Add or Add All to copy the selected CPL files or sites to the
Selected CPL Files list box. Click Remove or Remove All to remove
the site from the Selected CPL Files list box.
18. Click Restore to begin the restoring process. The Site Restore dialog
box displays.
Note:
To over write all selected locations, check the Overwrite all
selected sites check box. Any sites that fail are listed at the end
of the restore process.
The selected site database backup file and selected CPL files are
restored to the locations you selected.
BMTX-SVP01A-EN 593
Restoring into the Tracer Summit Workstation
3. To change the source path of the graphics, click Browse. The Browse
for Folder dialog box displays.
4. Select a file location path.
5. Click OK. The Restore Graphic dialog box displays.
6. Click Global Graphics to restore the graphics that are common to
multiple sites.
7. Select the graphics to be restored from the Details window. Click
Select All to select all global graphics.
8. Click OK to restore the selected graphics.
594 BMTX-SVP01A-EN
Restoring Site Graphics
Note:
The restore function for site graphics is required only for cre-
ation of a node on the Navigation Tree. Once this node is cre-
ated, it is no longer necessary (or possible) to restore. The
updated files (.GIF, .BMP, .JPG, .HTM, .AVI) can be copied via
Windows Explorer to the correct directory.
3. To change the path where backup graphics are located, click Browse.
The Browse for Folder dialog box displays.
4. Select the directory location.
5. Click OK. The Restore Graphic dialog box displays.
6. Click Site Graphics to restore graphics specific to a site.
7. Select the site to restore from the drop-down list.
8. Select the graphics to be restored from the Details window. Click
Select All to select all site graphics.
BMTX-SVP01A-EN 595
Restoring into the Tracer Summit Workstation
Restoring a Report
You can restore backup report files to the original PC Workstation or a
new PC Workstation.
To restore a report:
1. From the Tools menu, select Restore. Additional items display.
2. Select Reports. The Select Report Backup File dialog box displays (see
Figure 499).
3. Select the file location of the backup report from the Look In field.
4. Select the report file to restore.
5. Click Open to restore the selected report. You are returned to the
Tracer Summit main window.
6. To view the restored reports, click Reports.
596 BMTX-SVP01A-EN
Restoring Operator Display Custom Screens
5. Click the Available Sites arrow to select the site whose custom
screens you want to restore.
6. Select the BCU from the Available BCUs list. The selected BCU dis-
plays in the Available BCUs field.
7. In the Custom Screens list, select the custom screens that you want to
restore.
8. Click Add to add the screens to the Selected Custom Screens list (see
Figure 500).
9. Click OK. The Tracer Summit software restores the selected custom
screens to the selected BCU.
BMTX-SVP01A-EN 597
Restoring into the Tracer Summit Workstation
598 BMTX-SVP01A-EN
Chapter 37
From time to time you may need to delete an object or a site from the
database because:
• An object such as analog or binary input was created for troubleshoot-
ing purposes
• An object was placed in a database by mistake
• The database has grown and you want to reduce the number of
objects in it
• A site is no longer needed
Although you can delete either an object or a site, the procedure has some
built-in safeguards:
• If you are trying to delete an object that is referenced by other objects,
the references to the object you want to delete must be replaced with
references to other objects.
Note:
Object editing should not be done while a deletion is in process
(other than editing references to a object you want to delete).
• If any user is logged on to the site you want to delete, they must log
off before you can delete the site. You cannot be logged onto the site
you want to delete.
Note:
Only users with security access can delete objects or sites. For
more information, see Chapter 10, “Setting Up Security—
Tracer Summit System.”
BMTX-SVP01A-EN 599
Deleting Objects and Sites
Deleting Objects
The basic steps in deleting an object are:
1. Select the objects you want to delete (see “Selecting Objects to Delete”
on page 600).
2. Search to determine if other objects are dependent on (reference) that
object (see “Searching for Referencers” on page 601).
3. If other objects are referencing the object you want to delete, you
must edit those references (see “Opening and Editing the Referencing
Object Editor” on page 602). If no other objects reference the object
you want to delete, go to the next step.
4. Delete the objects (see “Deleting the Objects” on page 605).
2. Make a selection:
• To delete objects (UCMs, applications, input/output devices,
graphics, and so on) from the site you are currently logged onto,
click Current Site Objects.
• To delete graphics that have been saved as global, click Global
Site Objects.
3. Click OK. The Select Object(s) to Delete dialog box displays with a list
of the object types and all instances of that object (see Figure 502 on
page 601).
600 BMTX-SVP01A-EN
Deleting Objects
4. In the Select Object Type list box, scroll to the type of object you want
to delete. All of the objects of that type are displayed by name in the
Available Names list box.
5. Click on the names of the objects you plan to delete in the Available
Names list.
6. Click Add to add the selected names to the Selected Object Names
list.
7. Use Add, Add All, Remove, and Remove All to change the Selected
Object Names list. If you want to delete all objects of the same type,
use Add All. If you want to delete several—but not all—objects of the
same type, highlight and add them one at a time.
8. Click Search. (The Search button is available only if you have selected
at least one item to delete.)
9. Continue to the next section.
BMTX-SVP01A-EN 601
Deleting Objects and Sites
If there are objects that you want to delete listed in Objects That Cannot
Be Deleted list box, go to the section “Opening and Editing the Referenc-
ing Object Editor” on page 602.
Otherwise, finish deleting the objects (proceed to the section “Deleting the
Objects” on page 605).
602 BMTX-SVP01A-EN
Deleting Objects
BMTX-SVP01A-EN 603
Deleting Objects and Sites
3. On the new screen, click the referencer button in the appropriate ref-
erencer edit control field (see Figure 505).
Referencer
button
4. In the Select Property Reference dialog box, you must choose a differ-
ent object to replace the object you want to delete. Select a new object
with the Type or Name fields, then select the property you want that
is associated with that object.
5. Click OK. You return to the referencing object’s editor window.
6. If there are referencer changes in any other editor screen of this
object, click the tab for that screen.
7. Make the changes by repeating steps 3-6 for each property listed in
the Objects Is Referenced By list box, until no more fields reference
the object you wish to delete.
8. Click Save to save the changes in the object editor.
9. Click Close to close the object editor window and return to the Delete
Objects Search Results screen. The object for which you have changed
the references will now be able to be deleted and will be displayed in
the Objects That Can Be Deleted list box.
10. Proceed to the next section.
604 BMTX-SVP01A-EN
Deleting Objects
2. Click Yes. For each object listed in the Objects That Can Be Deleted
box, a confirmation prompt displays (see Figure 508).
3. Click Yes to All to continue the deletion process. All of the objects
listed in the Objects That Can Be Deleted list box are removed from
the database.
4. Click Finish. You are returned to the Tracer Summit main screen.
BMTX-SVP01A-EN 605
Deleting Objects and Sites
Deleting a Site
The procedure for deleting sites is similar to the procedure for deleting
objects. The main difference is that Tracer Summit searches for security
rights that allow you to delete a site, not for references to the objects that
you want to delete.
To delete a site, you must follow these rules:
• You must be logged onto a site in order to delete another site.
• If only one site is available, you cannot delete a site.
• You cannot delete the site you are logged onto (see the next section for
steps in how to log off of the current site).
Note:
Deleting a site removes it from the PC Workstation, but not
from the BCUs.
IMPORTANT
Deleting a site removes all graphics. If you might want the data again,
then back up the site before deleting it.
606 BMTX-SVP01A-EN
Deleting a Site
3. Click OK. The Select Site(s) to Delete dialog box is displayed. The list
of sites is shown in the Available Sites list box (see Figure 510).
BMTX-SVP01A-EN 607
Deleting Objects and Sites
Note:
Sites that have users logged on cannot be deleted. If you are
currently logged on to the site you want to delete, it is unavail-
able for deleting. See “Deleting a Site You Are Currently
Logged Onto” on page 606.
7. Click Delete Object. A message tells you that all editors will be closed
(see Figure 512 on page 609).
608 BMTX-SVP01A-EN
Deleting a Site
8. Click Yes. For each site listed in the Site(s) That Can Be Deleted box,
a confirmation prompt displays (see Figure 513).
9. Click Yes if you want to continue with the deletion. The site and all
associated objects, including graphics, are removed from the data-
base.
BMTX-SVP01A-EN 609
Deleting Objects and Sites
610 BMTX-SVP01A-EN
Chapter 38
Resetting a Device
The Tracer Summit System allows you to reset a BCU at four different
levels. In order of least to greatest impact on the BCU, the reset levels
are:
1. Reset
2. Clear BCU RAM and Reset
3. Clear Database, RAM, and Reset
4. Clear Code, Database, RAM, and Reset
For detailed information about reset levels, see Table 28 on page 615.
The reset procedures are typically done by selecting BCU Reset/Restore
from the Tools menu in Tracer Summit.
3. Click the BCUs you wish to reset in the Choose BCUs to Reset box. To
select all the BCUs, click Select All. To clear the current selections,
click Select None.
4. Click the desired level of reset in the Choose BCU Reset Level field.
BMTX-SVP01A-EN 611
Resetting a Device
5. If you select Clear Code, Database, RAM and Reset, click the arrow to
the right of the Code Version field to select the version of code you
wish to download into the BCUs.
6. Click Reset to reset the selected BCUs. The Reset/Restore dialog box
closes, and you return to the previous screen.
Reset
To reset, cycle power to the BCU by unplugging and re-plugging the
24 Vac power connector at the top of the termination board.
CAUTION
If you wait longer than 10 seconds, the BCU code and database may be
cleared as well as its RAM.
5. As soon as the LED display shows E with the decimal point flashing,
turn off power.
6. Set the DIP switch to its proper position.
7. Turn on power. The LED display should show the following sequence:
8, 7, 6, 4, 3, 2, H, –, “dancing dash”
612 BMTX-SVP01A-EN
Clear Database, RAM, and Reset
Note:
You must have a PC Workstation connected, and that worksta-
tion must contain the appropriate version of BCU code. If the
PC Workstation is not connected, the procedure will have no
effect on the BCU.
4. Turn off power and set the DIP switch to its proper position.
5. Turn on power and observe the following sequence: 8, 7, 6, 5, 4, 3, 2, 1,
-P,Pd, “dancing dash.”
BMTX-SVP01A-EN 613
Resetting a Device
614 BMTX-SVP01A-EN
Clear Comm5 database
BMTX-SVP01A-EN 615
Resetting a Device
When you restore a Tracer 100 site with several panels, the Remote
Unit to Restore list displays all of the site panels. The list is sorted by
ascending unit numbers, with unit 1 as the Tracer 100 COP.
3. Click the Browse button to find the .SAV file in the workstation data-
base.
4. From the Remote Unit to Restore list, select the panel that you want
to restore.
5. Click OK.
• If you are not currently connected to the site, Tracer Summit
automatically connects to the panel. The Restore in Progress dia-
log box appears. (The restore process can last as long as 15 min-
utes.)
616 BMTX-SVP01A-EN
Restoring a Tracer 100 Panel
BMTX-SVP01A-EN 617
Resetting a Device
618 BMTX-SVP01A-EN
Glossary
A Alarm
An audible or visual signal from a Building Management System that
warns of an abnormal and critical operating condition.
Analog
Data represented as a variable value, such as temperature control or flow.
Application
A specific program or task to which a computer solution can be applied.
Application program
A computer program designed to meet specific user needs, such as a pro-
gram that controls or monitors a process. Examples: Time of Day Sched-
uling, Chiller Plant Control.
Array
A list of elements. In the case of Chiller Plant Control, a list of identical
properties used for each chiller identified as a member of the chiller
plant.
Auto refresh
Ability to view events in the Event Log viewer without manual interven-
tion. Any events normally seen by pushing the manual refresh button in
Tracer Summit version 12 can be seen automatically if auto refreshing is
enabled.
Auto Save
Process of saving the event log using the workstation Task Manager.
BMTX-SVP01A-EN 619
Glossary
B Backup copy
One or more files that are copied onto a storage medium for safekeeping
in case the original gets damaged or lost.
BACnet
A standard communication protocol developed by the American Society of
Heating, Refrigeration, and Air Conditioning Engineers. It defines how
information will be packaged for transportation between building auto-
mation system (BAS) vendors.
BCU-ELO
Building Control Unit-Event Log Object.
BCU
Building control unit.
Billing period
The period of time between consecutive readings of the utility company
meters for billing purposes.
Binary
• A number system with only two digits, 0 and 1, in which each symbol
represents a decimal power of two; or
• Any system that has only two possible states or levels, such as a
switch that is either on or off. (On is represented as 1 and off is repre-
sented as 0.); or
• The presence of voltage (equivalent to 1) or absence of voltage (equiv-
alent of 0) in a computer circuit.
620 BMTX-SVP01A-EN
Glossary
C Calculated analog
A term synonymous with point type 11. Calculated analogs are logical or
software analog points that are similar to analog output and analog
inputs, except they are not associated with hardware. Calculated analogs
can be used in most Tracer 100 programs as analog inputs or outputs.
Calculated analogs are most frequently used as setpoints for direct digital
control (DDC) loops, and various types of ICS equipment such as SCP,
AHU, and TCM, etc. These calculated analog setpoints can be set by the
operator or calculated using the process control language (PCL) program.
Calculated binary
A term synonymous with point type 08. Calculated binaries are logical or
software binary points that are similar to binary outputs, except they are
not associated with hardware. Calculated binaries can be controlled by
any Tracer Building Control program, just like binary outputs (point type
05). You can use the on/off status of calculated binaries in other Tracer
Summit programs in place of binary inputs or binary outputs.
Capacity
The maximum output of the equipment. For example, “The chiller has a
capacity of 800 tons.”
CenTraVac
Trane’s registered name for the line of hermetic centrifugal refrigeration
machines that provide chilled water for comfort or industrial water cool-
ing installations. The CenTraVac chiller name has also been applied to
include certain models of Trane’s helical rotary chiller.
BMTX-SVP01A-EN 621
Glossary
Chiller sequencing
An integral part of the chiller plant control that sequences and automati-
cally rotates up to six chillers and their associated pumps to optimize
individual chiller runtime and system performance.
Code
A software program, running in the BCU, equivalent to the operating sys-
tem of a personal computer. It controls the physical operation of the BCU. It
is different from the CPL code that a technician would write.
Communication link
A set of wires connected from one device to another that is used to trans-
mit information between the devices. This link is typically a twisted pair
of wires for Trane building management systems.
Configuration
The functional arrangement of a system. Usually set by computer inter-
face or DIP switch settings.
Context object
A UCM or an application object defined when a user launches a graphic
from the navigation tree, a graphic target, or from the UCM or applica-
tion editor.
COP Tracer
Communications Processor. A term applied to the lead Tracer 100 Series
panel in a unit-to-unit configuration. The COP panel uses address 1.
Communicating with unit-to-unit Tracer 100 panels can only occur as a
pass-through of the COP Tracer. The communications baud rate is limited
to 1200 baud.
Custom graphic
• A hard-coded graphic created by a user in Tracer Summit; or
622 BMTX-SVP01A-EN
Glossary
Custom screen
An operator display screen created by an installer/programmer. It always
has a Home button and might include a monochrome bitmap, data items,
and custom navigation buttons.
D DAC
Discharge Air Controller profile.
Database
A computer file that contains all site-specific information used by a BCU to
control site operation. This file is stored in the PC Workstation and in indi-
vidual BCUs on the network. In the PC Workstation, the file is named sum-
mit.mdb and is located in C:\Program Files\Tracer Summit\Database
directory.
Demand limiting
A function that reduces electrical demand by measuring incoming electri-
cal power and either turning off specified loads or adjusting temperature
setpoints to keep energy usage below a prescribed level during the
demand interval.
Device
Computer hardware that performs some specific function. Input devices
such as a keyboard are used to get information into the CPU. Output
devices, such as a printer, are used to take information out of a computer
in some usable form. Input/output devices are able to perform both input
and output of information.
Diagnostic
A program that checks the operation of a device board or other component
for malfunctions and errors and reports its findings.
Diagnostic report
A form of standard live report for displaying diagnostics from the active
UCM status data location within Tracer 100 and Tracker panels. For
BCU sites, the upload is from UCMs and analog input and binary input
objects.
DIP switches
Configuration switches of various components of the building manage-
ment system. Placing each individual DIP switch either on or off config-
ures the address and the function of the miscellaneous control
components of the building management system.
BMTX-SVP01A-EN 623
Glossary
Discovery
The process of finding all online controllers on a Comm5 link and display-
ing their Neuron IDs and Location Labels.
Display
In this document, the term display is used to refer to the touchscreen dis-
play device.
E Economizer control
The opening or closing of various HVAC dampers to cool a building with
outside air, usually when the outside air is 40ºF to 65ºF.
EEPROM
Electrically erasable programmable read-only memory. An electronic chip
that can store information such as control set points, be reprogrammed in
the field, and maintain its memory during a power loss.
EIA-232
Interface standard used for communications between peripheral devices
and energy management systems.
E-mail profile
A group of settings that define how the mail server is set up for a particu-
lar user. For example, a profile may include access to a mailbox on
Microsoft Exchange Server and specify that the Outlook Address Book
appears in the Address Book dialog box.
E-mail recipient
In message forwarding, just an e-mail address. A forwarded alarm mes-
sage can be retrieved by a person using a client-side e-mail program such
as Microsoft Outlook or an e-mail-supported pager service provider, or
both.
Ethernet
Networking standards that transmit data at 10 Mbps using a specified
protocol. Ethernet is a popular LAN technology.
Event log
A listing of events such as alarms and control actions that can be viewed
by the building management system operator.
624 BMTX-SVP01A-EN
Glossary
Event
Generated by an alarm, a diagnostic, a user operation such as controlling
a point or object, logging on/off, or acknowledging alarms. Typically, an
event turns into an alarm if it has been set up to beep and/or require
acknowledgement.From the point of view of the user, several types of
inputs to the control system generate an event.
Extranet
Proprietary Internet site for Trane personnel to access when not able to
get to TraneNet.
F Filtering
Filtering is used to display only the rows of events that meet user-speci-
fied criteria. In other words, rows that do not match the criteria are elim-
inated from the displayed list.
G Global change
A mechanism through which a user can change the setup of many objects
of the same type in one action, rather than having to open every object to
make the change.
Global graphic
A graphic that can be used to display information for any site. A graphic
object is created in the system site and is available for use by all sites con-
nected to the PC Workstation.
Global objects
Includes the workstation modem, global graphic, keyboard macros, group
security, group configuration, and message forwarding.
Graphic
A compilation of Summit-supplied information and images that form a
display of information on the PC. A graphic requires a graphic object in
the database, an HTML file, and one or more image files to be in a specific
file structure under the \Graphics subdirectory in Tracer Summit.
Graphics can be displayed from the navigation tree, from a UCM editor,
from a graphic target field, or from the main menu.
Group
• An organization of one or more devices under a single name; or
• A collection of sites or groups in the Tracer Summit database that
exist as an object in the system. The user can perform an action on a
group, which in turn will propagate that action to every site or group
of sites that belongs to the group
BMTX-SVP01A-EN 625
Glossary
H Hard-coded graphic
A graphic that contains no template fields. All the information that is
needed to display the data in the fields on the graphic is stored in the
HTML file for the graphic. This graphic does not require a context to dis-
play its information in the graphic fields. It can appear on the navigation
tree without having to be assigned by the navigation tree editor.
HTML file
A file that is written in Hypertext Markup Language, a standard coding
language used to create HyperText documents for use on the World Wide
Web or an intranet network. A file of this type is required for a graphic
object to be displayed. The file must be in the \Graphics directory under
the standard, custom, or site name subdirectories. The Tracer Summit
Graphics Editor creates the file along with the graphic object.
Information maintained in the file includes all graphic fields (types, prop-
erties, positions, size, and order of display) and image references (names,
type, position, size, and order of display). The file also keeps the necessary
information from the graphic object to take the object from one PC Work-
station to another. This file cannot be used in a Web Browser to display
Tracer Summit information.
HVAC
Heating, ventilating, and air conditioning. Building mechanical system
equipment.
I Image
File used by a graphic to display a photo or picture.
L LAN
Local Area Network
LCD
Liquid crystal display. The display screen that is an integral part of the
operator display.
Level 0
Security level at which the user can view the grouping structure from the
Group Setup dialog box but cannot access grouping functionality in Glo-
bal Changes, Task Manager, or Message Forwarding. User cannot access
Group Security.
Level 1
Security level at which the user can view the grouping structure from the
Group Setup dialog box but cannot edit group setup. User can access
626 BMTX-SVP01A-EN
Glossary
Level 2
Users have full group access. They can access and edit group security and
group setup. They can access grouping functionality in Global Changes,
Task Manager, and Message Forwarding.
BMTX-SVP01A-EN 627
Glossary
M Macro
A key that is set up by the user to execute often-used keystroke sequences
on the PC.
MAPI
Messaging Application Programming Interface. A messaging architecture
and a client interface component for applications such as electronic mail,
scheduling, calendaring, and document management. As a messaging
architecture, MAPI provides a consistent interface for multiple applica-
tion programs to interact with multiple messaging systems across a vari-
ety of hardware platforms.
Source: The Free On-line Dictionary of Computing, © 1993-2001 Denis
Howe
N Navigation scheme
The way in which screens and graphics are linked together. It defines
what will happen next when the user touches a target on the BCU opera-
tor display.
Navigation tree
The panel on the left-hand side of the main Tracer Summit window that
displays all sites, buildings, areas, and HVAC equipment set up for the
system.
Night economize
Setting that uses cool, dry outside air during unoccupied periods to pre-
cool a building, thus minimizing the use of mechanical cooling.
Night heat/cool
Setting that provides mechanical heating/cooling during unoccupied peri-
ods to bring space temperature back to within a predefined range.
O Object
An element recognized by the Tracer Summit database. Objects may be
input and output points, UCMs or applications.
Object instance
At a site there may be many units of a particular object type installed:
Centrifugal Chillers, VAV II/IIIs, and Voyagers, etc. An object instance
refers to a unit installed on the link Chiller 1 or Voyager 12. Each object
instance will have a unique address used to identify it to the building
automation system.
Offline
The operational state of a device when not communicating on the net-
work.
628 BMTX-SVP01A-EN
Glossary
Online
The operational state of a device when communicating on the network or
with a control device.
Operator display
A liquid crystal display (LCD) mounted on a modular BCU for basic oper-
ator functions including viewing a local BCU event log. The operator dis-
play consists of an LCD with a printed circuit to control the display.
Additional components include a time clock and external memory. The
operator display is equipped with a touch screen as a user input device.
Optimal start
The process of efficiently starting HVAC equipment so that the occupied
setpoints will be achieved at the appropriate time. The Tracer Summit
system, for instance, may be programmed for occupied temperature at
6:00 a.m., but with optimal start, may start at 5:15 a.m. to enable temper-
ature control to be achieved by 6:00 a.m.
P Panel
A term generally used for Tracer 100 Series or Trackers units that are
monitored from a central location.
Priority control
The ability to define custom control sequences that respond to alarm con-
ditions. Priority control sequences receive the highest priority; they over-
ride all other control sequences.
Property
One element of an object’s characteristic information. This information
element can be viewed, referenced, and applied throughout the Tracer
Summit system.
BMTX-SVP01A-EN 629
Glossary
R RAM
A type of computer memory located on the BCU logic board that is used to
store temporary data such as operator overrides, UCM scan data, and CPL
saved values.
Referencer
An edit control in Tracer Summit editors that allows the value of one
property to be set equal to the value of another property.
RS-232
(see EIA-232)
Runtime view
The presentation of a graphic in Tracer Summit with live, updated data.
S Scan
A connection to designated Tracer 100 panels that retrieves status infor-
mation, and downloads changes to schedules, holidays, and trends, etc.
Like BMN, Tracer Summit can scan Tracer 100 panels as well as BCU
sites.
SCC
Space Comfort Controller profile.
630 BMTX-SVP01A-EN
Glossary
Setpoint
Typically a zone sensor or thermostat (STAT) heat/cool value to be main-
tained by the system.
Site
A logical grouping of equipment serving a single facility. The customer
defines the site as a logical grouping.
Site graphic
A graphic that is available only to a specific site (a custom site graphic).
SMTP
Simple Mail Transfer Protocol. A protocol defined in STD 10, RFC 821,
used to transfer electronic mail between computers, usually over Ether-
net. It is a server to server protocol, so other protocols are used to access
the messages. The SMTP dialog usually happens in the background
under the control of the message transport system, e.g. sendmail but it is
possible to interact with an SMTP server using telnet to connect to the
normal SMTP port, 25.
Source: The Free On-line Dictionary of Computing, © 1993-2001 Denis
Howe
Sorting
To arrange the information alphanumerically in a given column of a
table.
Standard screen
The menu-driven screens that allow the user to navigate within the BCU
operator display. Depending on the context, a standard screen will have
any combination of static text, live text, and/or icons.
Static text
Text that does not come from the Tracer Summit database. The only way
to change static text is by using the display setup editor. The title for a
custom graphic screen is an example of static text.
Status
An indication of a condition which may or may not be normal. An alarm
may be a response to an abnormal status, and may be recorded in an
event log.
Syntax
A set of rules for a programming language.
BMTX-SVP01A-EN 631
Glossary
System security
A method of maintaining or restricting access to the building manage-
ment system. Typically, a four-digit code enables access to override or con-
trol the system.
T Target field
A graphic field that launches another graphic from within Tracer Summit
(either a Target field, a Target image, or a Target button) or a graphic
field that links to a source outside of Tracer Summit (a Target External
button).
Target link
A graphic field (a target field, target image, or target button) that is
linked to another graphic screen. When the user touches this target link,
the screen to which the target is linked displays.
Task
In the Task Manager application, an operation or series of operations that
are performed by a workstation. Examples of tasks include automatically
initiating communications to a site or performing a backup of a site data-
base.
Template graphic
A graphic that contains at least one field for which the information
required to display Tracer Summit data depends on the object for which
the graphic is being displayed. All standard graphics are template
graphics.
Touch
The user/operator touches a target on the BCU Operator Display. This is
the touch screen equivalent to a keyboard or mouse input at the worksta-
tion.
632 BMTX-SVP01A-EN
Glossary
Touch screen
A transparent overlay on an LCD or computer screen that is sensitive to
touch by a finger or stylus.
Tracer remote
A term generally used for Tracer 100 Series panels (also referred to sim-
ply as panel, remote, remote unit, and remote panel, etc.) that are moni-
tored from a central location.
Tracer Summit
Trane’s premier building management system that allows facility manag-
ers to operate a building in an optimized and efficient manner. Tracer
Summit gives the facility operator control of temperature, humidity,
scheduling, lighting, energy, and much more. All of these building control
capabilities can be programmed and managed as a single system through
Tracer Summit.
Tracker
The Tracker building automation system is Trane’s building management
system for small, light commercial buildings. It consists of an operator
display on the Tracker controller and a menu-driven interface program in
the embedded software.
BMTX-SVP01A-EN 633
Glossary
TraneNet
Proprietary internal intranet site for Trane offices.
Trend log
Retains a historical record of values for specified points.
Unit-to-unit
The Tracer 100 Series system that has models capable of being configured
with a COP Tracer with up to seven slave Tracers connected to it over an
18 AWG twisted, shielded-pair wire LAN. The Tracer Summit system
communicates to the slave Tracer 100 through the modem on the COP
Tracer.
W Wizard
An application utility that helps you step through a particular task
related to the application. For example, the Site Connection Wizard in
Tracer Summit leads you through the steps of connecting to various sites
using different communication media.
Workstation
Refers to a personal computer, either a laptop or a desktop, that is loaded
with the Tracer Summit software and the Setup editor software.
634 BMTX-SVP01A-EN
Glossary
BMTX-SVP01A-EN 635
Glossary
Z Zone
The smallest area of control in an HVAC system. It is characterized by
having a single thermostat or zone temperature sensor. A room served by
a single VAV box is an example of a zone. Several rooms served by the
same VAV box also constitute a zone.
636 BMTX-SVP01A-EN
Index
BMTX-SVP01A-EN 637
Index
Definition, 283 Input/output objects for, 580, Binary inputs, setting up, 267
Enabling and disabling night 586 Calculating the pulse multiplier,
economizing, 294 Input/output points, 586 266
Enabling and disabling timed Protocol, uses in Tracer Summit, Creating, 262, 531
override, 293 573 Pulse metered inputs, setting
Membership rules, 289 Providing information to other up, 266
Operating modes, standard systems, 580 BCU modem
behavior, 284 Running report of objects, 587 Configuring, 160
Releasing control to property, Troubleshooting, 526 Creating new, 159
298 Using for non-Trane devices, Editor, accessing, 158
Security access to an area, 296 573 Phone book, managing, 161
Start timed override (TOV) BACnet device(s) Redialing, 159
request, 298 Creating in a site, 69 Security access to, 164
Area node, 381 Default device ID, 71 Setting up, 159
Array Deleting from a site, 72 BCU object
Definition, 619 Editing in a site, 71 Viewing and modifying, 191
Using in CPL text file, 364 Name, dependent on device ID, BCU objects
Auto log off 70 Present value, modifying, 191
Minutes for, 174 BACnet protocols Uploading and downloading,
Security option, 174 See BACnet device(s) 191
AutoCAD, 446, 568 BACnet/IP BDB files, 203, 394, 598
Autocommissioning VAVs in VAS Site connection for, 37, 38 Task manager site backups, 202
Comm5, 314 Balancing, system, 312 Beep
Automatic connection of sites, from BAS (building automation system), Causing when event message
navigation tree, 528 definition, 621 received, 84
Automatic remote connection Base chiller, 278 Preventing at workstation, 519
security option, 174 BBMD IP address, 39 Billing period
Autoselecting image size, 420 BCU Defining, 80
Average calculation, 480 Adding modem for, 60 Definition, 620
AVI movie, 446 clear code, database, RAM, and Scheduling calculations around,
Autoselecting size, 420 reset procedure, 613 487
Inserting, 410 clear Comm5 database, 614 Used as a sampling interval, 474
Setup information for, 427 clear database, RAM, and reset Binary animation field, setup
procedure, 613 information for, 426
clear RAM and reset procedure, Binary input
B 612 Alarm scenarios, 241
Connection, programming Alarm state, cause of, 241
Back button, 429 without, See Offline Assigning expanded message,
Background programming 452
Changing for a graphic, 414 Creating for a site, 57 Binary input editor, 240
Locating image for, 416 Definition, 621 Binary, definition, 620
Backing up, 591 Deleting from a site, 65 BMTX, 259
Backing up function Deleting modem from, 64 Class, entering, 243
and groups of sites, 203 Deleting when contains objects, Creating, 239
Backup function, 591 65, 68, 72 Defining referencer for, 239
Backup copy, definition, 620 Device ID, assigning, 58 Definition, 239, 620
Backup during site setup, 7 Device ID, default, 58 Expanded message for, 243
Restoring from a backup, 591 Editing in a site, 61 In CPL routine, 252
Task manager, and Modem, See BCU modem Naming, 239
Backing up BCU sites, 202 Operator display, and, 529 Routing of alarm, 243
Tracer 100 backups, 203 Pagers and, See Pager Binary output
See also Task manager Required for site creation, 57 Binary output editor, 248
BACnet Resetting, See Reset function Binary, definition, 620
BACnet ID, 586 Role in BACnet setup, 581 Calculated, 196
Communications flow, 581 Role in online programming, 11 Class, entering, 249
Control priorities, 578 Selecting for CPL program, 370 Creating, 247
Creating input/output object for, Version, selecting, 79 Defining referencer for, 247
586 Viewing memory for trend Definition, 247, 621
Definition, 573, 620 sampling, 477 Global references, setting up,
Electronic file, 589 BCU I/O Module Object 250
Analog inputs, setting up, 266 Globally change, 195
638 BMTX-SVP01A-EN
Index
Modifying the present value, Creating, 489 Tracer 100 or Tracker panels, 125
193 Deleting, 494 Tracer 100 or Tracker sites, 154
Naming, 247 Security access to, 494 Connecting to a site from the
Overriding, 253 Setting up, 491 navigation tree, 383
Present value, changing, 255 See also Calculation Connection
Saving, 249 Calling card, 162 Non-Trane devices, types of
Standard behavior in an area, Capacity, definition, 621 connections for, 573
284 CCD, See Total Cooling Degree Connection status
Binary text field, setup information Days ARCNET status, 31
for, 425 CenTraVac, definition, 621 BACnet/IP, 31
Custom screen editor, and, 558 Changeover voting, 324 Determining, 30
Blank row Chiller EIA-232, 31
Adding to a report, 506 CenTraVac, definition, 621 Ethernet, 31
Purpose in a report, 503 Failure, 271 Not Connected status, 31
BMP file format, 416, 446, 450 Setting up UCM for, 280 Constant mode in referencers, 20
Custom screen editor, and, 561 Units, 280 Constant volume system,
BMS (building management See also Chiller plant definition, 622
system), definition, 621 Chiller plant Context for a graphic, 418
Body text Adding members, 277 Target fields, 431
Formatting for reports, 508 Base sequence, 278 See also Template field
Report members displayed in, Chiller object settings, 277, 279 Control application
506 Control capabilities, 271, 327 Assigning, 579
Boolean, 362, 363 Creating new, 273, 329 Modifying, 579
Border, editing for graphic fields, Creating new objects for, 273 Control class, 579
427 Definition, 622 In VAS Comm3/Comm4, 325
Break in CPL program, 374 Duplicate chiller types, 278 Control mode in referencers, 20
Building automation control Normal sequence, 278 Control priorities
network, See BACnet Peak sequence, 278 BACnet and, 578
Security access to, 280 Defaults, selecting, 578
Sequence types, 278 Definition, 86, 578
C Sequencing, definition, 622 Setting up, 86
Startup settings, 275 Setting up for BACnet Devices,
Calculated analog and binary Subtract settings, 276 578
objects, 196 Swing sequence, 278 Conversion factor
Accessing the editor, 197 System setup, 274 For a Cool Flow Rate
Terminal emulation, and, 196 See also Chiller calculation, 481
Uploading and downloading, Chiller plant editor, 271 For a Heat Flow Rate
191, 196 Accessing, 272, 328 calculation, 482
Calculation Code For a Peak X Minute Interval
Adding to a report, 505 Writing in CPL, 351 calculation, 484
Average, 480 Column heading, entering for Cool Flow Rate calculation, 480
Billing periods, scheduling reports, 507 COP panel, 129
around, 487 Comment, adding, 356 Creating, 129
Cool Flow Rate, 480 Common space Definition, 129
Defining billing period for, 80 VAVs, 306 See also Tracer 100 or Tracker
Editor, accessing, 487 Communication link sites
Enabling, 492 Changing once created, 63 Copy a site
Heat Flow Rate, 482 Definition, 622 BCU, 54
Maximum, 483 In non-Trane setup, 580 Objects not copied
Meter Totalization, 483 Communications port Tracer 100 or Tracker sites,
Minimum, 483 PC workstation modem, 156 122
Object, See Calculation object Tracer 100 or Tracker panels, 392 Objects not copied, BCU sites,
Peak for X Minute Interval, 484 Compile function, 368 54
Pulse meter input, 260 Compile report, 368 Tracer 100 or Tracker site, 122
Total Cooling Degree Days, 485 Failure, 369 CorelDRAW, 446, 568
Total Heating Degree Days, 486 Viewing errors in source files, CPL, 351
Total Run Hours/Starts, 487 369 Definition, 622
Types, list of, 480 Configuration, definition, 622 Error codes, 376
Using in live reports, 496 Configuring communication How area control affects, 284
Calculation object settings, 77 Library of sample programs,
Clearing data from, 493 BCU sites, 153 351, 353
BMTX-SVP01A-EN 639
Index
640 BMTX-SVP01A-EN
Index
Disconnect remote connection Assigning for present value, 295 Folder, see Directory
security option, 174 Assigning for timed override Fonts in a graphic, 428
Drive max airflow, 325 (TOV), 295 Footer, entering for reports, 508
Duct pressure optimization in VAS Event log For more information about Tracer
Comm5, 309 Adding a BCU event log object, Summit, 4
Duty cycle, Tracer 100, 340 60 Frequency of running CPL program,
Dynamic values, appearance of Archiving, 202, 205 setting, 370
when offline, 13 Creating expanded message for Frequency of trend sampling, See
a graphic, 452 Interval
Definition, 624 Function
E New features, 1 Adding in CPL text file, 357
Printer selection, 517 Assigning access to, 174
Economizer control, definition, 624 Printing, 148
Edit level of security, definition, 169 Saving archive as text or Excel
EEPROM, definition, 624 file, 212 G
Effective period of a schedule, 345 Settings, changing, 517
EIA-232 connection See also Task manager GIF file format, 416, 446, 450
Configuring modem object for, Event receiver, 82 Global changes, 187
585 List of workstations and pagers, Calculated analog and binary
Creating modem object for, 584 85 objects, 196
Definition, 630 Event routing Globally changing sites
Modem object setup required, For each receiver, 85 Applying changes to a single
580 Setting up, 82 site, 188
Electronic file, using to input Events in a schedule, See Applying changes to
BACnet data, 589 Scheduling, 333 multiple sites, 189
Electronic library, 25 Events printer Groups, and, 185
Ellipsis button, 21 Definition, 148 Modifying BCU objects, 191
Archiving event log, Task Setting up and selecting, 148 Object types you can change,
manager, 212 Exception in a schedule, 333 187
See also ... button, 21 Exceptions Offline programming, and, 18
Ellipsis, See Referencer button Adding to time of day reports, Task manager, and, 201
END statement, 355 350 Global graphic
Energy conservation Expanded message Backing up, 591
Accomplishing with chiller plant Backing up, 591 Definition, 445, 625
control, 271 Creating, 452 Effect of selecting save option,
Monitoring pulse meter input, Definition, 452 441, 442
260 Restoring from a backup, 594, Navigation tree, and, 387
Enumeration 595 Restoring from a backup, 594
Assigning in CPL text file, 361 Selecting for analog input Global references
Defining for priority shutdown, alarm, 237 Setting up for analog or binary
362 Selecting for binary input alarm, outputs, 250
Definition, 361 243 Setting up for VAS Comm5
Example, after assignment, 363 members, 310
Example, before assignment, Graphic
362 F Background, changing, 414
Error codes in CPL, interpreting, Basics, 408
376 Feedback reference Blank, 447
Error-30 through Error-307, 376 Definition, 241 Context for, 418, 431
Ethernet, definition, 624 Selecting, 242 Custom, See Custom graphic
Event Field in a graphic, See Graphic field Definition, 625
Adding, 340 File directories, changing default, Deleting, 459
Changing event time, 341 523 Deleting, renaming as
Removing, 342 File format alternative to, 444, 459
Event class Event log archive, 212 Displaying for UCM when
Example user-defined classes, as .SAV, 212 offline, 13
83 as .TXT, 212 Editing, 409
Labels for, 84 as Excel file, 212 Editor,See Graphics editor
Predefined classes, 82 File name Expanded message, See
Recommended notifications, 82 Auto generating for reports, 512 Expanded message
Trend snapshots and, 475 Specifying for a report, 512 Field,See Graphic field
Event Classes Fill in template option, 459 File formats for images, 416
BMTX-SVP01A-EN 641
Index
File name, 416 Status text field, 410, 555 Loop controller member,
Folders, 408 Target button field, 411, 555 assigning, 331
Global, definition, 445 Target External button field, 422, Need-to-run threshold, 327, 330
Grid, See Grid 432 Need-to-run votes, 329
Hard-coded graphic, definition, Target fields, 429 Night Heat/Cool operation, 327
626 Target image field, 411 WSHP compressor referencer,
Home, changing, 516 Target text field, 411 331
Inserting images, 450 Template field, See Template WSHP member, assigning, 331
Jumping to, See Target field field Heat/cool
Location, 416 Text style, editing, 427 Night heat/cool, See Night
Location search order, 440 Types of, 410 heat/cool
Options, 407 See also Custom screen editor VAV air system control, 321
Palette, See Graphics editor Adding control value fields, Holiday, 333
palette 558 Adding to time of day schedule
Properties, editing, 414 Graphic object, see Graphic reports, 350
Renaming, 444, 459 Graphics editor Holiday schedules, setting
Restoring, 443, 594, 595 Accessing, 409 Message forwarding and call
Saving, 439–440 Capabilities, 407 centers, 226
Security access to, 417 Using, 407 Home graphic, changing, 516
Setup, allocating workstations Graphics editor palette, 410 HTML file
for, 13 Graphing control editor Definition, 626
Site-specific, definition, 445 Creating a single trend object Name, 439
Standard, definition, 445 graph, 462 Role in deleting graphic, 459
Template field, See Template Creating live property graphs, Search sequence, 440
field 461 HVAC equipment
Uses of, 407 Using historical graphs, 460 Controlling with a schedule, 333
See also Custom screen editor Using live property graphs, 460 Definition, 626
Graphic field Graphs, See Graphing control During site setup, 8
Aligning multiple, 436 editor
Analog in 5 color field, 410 Grid
AVI movie field, 410 Color, changing, 413 I
Binary animation field, 410 Displaying on a graphic, 412
Binary check box field, 410 Snap to grid, disabling, 413 I/O, See Input/output object
Border, editing, 427 Snap to grid, enabling, 413 Image
Border, significance of cross- Spacing, configuring, 413 Autoselecting size, 420
hatching, 421, 422, 434 Using to organize fields, 412 Changing state assignment, 426
Border, significance of stripes, See also Custom screen editor Creating for a graphic, 446
434 Group of sites node, 381 Definition, 626
Copying, 436 Group security, 177 File formats, 416, 446
Cutting and pasting, 435 Group, definition, 625 Inserting in a graphic, 450
Deleting, 438 Grouping sites, 183 Locating, 416
Editing, 420, 421 Creating a group, 184 Saving, 446
External file sources, 432 Creating call centers for groups Setup information for, 427
Identifying type of, 421 of sites, 186 Sizes available, 447
Image field, 410 Creating scan tasks for groups, Inch-pound units, 56
Inserting, 420 186 Input
Making the same size, 437 Forwarding alarms from groups Metering for use in calculations,
Moving, 435 of sites through e-mail, 229 484, 485
Moving by one pixel, 435 Task manager, and, 210 See also Input object
Moving forward or back, 438 Using groups to make global Input object
Organizing with the grid, 412 changes, 185 Analog input, 234, 262
Override control field, 410, 555 Binary input, 239
Primary field, 434 Definition, 233
Property references for, 421 H Naming, 252
Resizing, 435 See also Input/output object
Secondary field, 434 HDD, See Total Heating Degree Input/output object
Selecting multiple, 434 Days Creating, 233, 259
Selection list control field, 410 Header .cpl file, 353 Creating for BACnet, 586
Setpoint control field, 410, 555 Heat Flow Rate calculation, 482 Modifying, 252
Setup information, 422, 423 Heat Pump Loop Control (HPLC) Naming, 252
Static text field, 410, 555 Role in BACnet setup, 581
642 BMTX-SVP01A-EN
Index
Security classes, 256 Lighting, how area control affects, Creating a call center, 222
Types of, 233, 262 284 Registering e-mail profiles,
Using during site setup, 8 Line-feed printer, 148 221
Using in BACnet, 580 Live report Scheduling when recipients
Viewing properties for, 27 Calculation, using in report, 496 receive e-mails, 223
See also Input object or Output Custom, selecting, 501 Test e-mail forwarding, 224
object Defining row for, 503 Meter Totalization calculation, 483
Input/output points for BACnet, 586 Definition, 496 Microsoft Windows
Input/output, See Input/output Member types, 496 Modem for PC workstation,
object Sample, 497 adding, 150
Insert prompt, 420 Standard, 499 Printer setup, 148
Interval Standard, membership rules Microsoft Windows Paint, 446, 568
Sampling interval for trend, 474 for, 503 Minimum calculation, 483
Selecting for reporting, 508 See also Report Mode button, 19
IP subnet, 37, 45 Local area network, See LAN Options, 20
I-P units, 56 Logging onto multiple sites, 173 Modem
Adding a Tracer 100 or Tracker
modem, 154
J M Adding for a site BCU, 60, 159
Adding for a workstation, 150
JPG file format, 416, 446, 450 Macro Adding object for EIA-232
See Keyboard macros connection, 584
Macro node, 382 BCU modem setup, 158
K Main image of a custom graphic, Configuring object for EIA-232
449 connection, 585
Keyboard macros Manually adding objects Deleting from BCU, 64
Accessing the macro editor, 396 Non-Trane device, 577 PC workstation modem setup,
Creating a macro, 397 Master workstation, 12 149
Editing from the navigation tree, Maximum calculation, 483 Security access to, 164
389 Member of a report Setting up, 149
Macro node icon, 382 Changing order of, 506 Monthly report, setting up, 510
Selecting predefined macros, Defining, 503 Morning warm up, See MWU
398 Member of a schedule, 343 settings
Tracer 100 predefined macros, Member of a trend Movement cursor, 435
400 Adding, 471 MWU settings, 320
Tracker predefined macros, 405 Definition, 471 MWU differential, 322
See also Navigation tree, 389 Editing, 471 MWU setpoint, 322
Including in a report, 498 Selecting, 322
Limited number allowed, 472
L Member of an area, adding, 288
Member of an object type, operator N
Labels, for event classes, 84 display, adding and deleting,
LAN 537–538 Name
Connection, programming See also Operator display Site, inability to modify, 35
without, See Offline Message forwarding and call Navigation tree
programming centers, 215 Connecting to a site from the
Layout Accessing the editor, 220 tree, 383
Changing in reports, 506 Alarms, forwarding, 228 Creating nodes, 384
Codes for reports, 506 Background considerations, 216 Assigning graphics to, 387
LEDs Call center, definition, 216 Basic considerations, 384
clear code, database, RAM, and Creating a message forwarding Creating nodes inside site
reset procedure, 613 schedule, 225 nodes, 385
clear Comm5 database, 614 Issues to consider before Cutting and pasting, 385
clear database, RAM, and reset creating a call center, 218 Finding a node, 386
procedure, 613 Selecting a site/group from Grouping nodes, 386
clear RAM and reset procedure, which alarms are sent, 229 Definition, 379, 628
612 Selecting alarm event classes, Different types of nodes, 381
Library 230 Editing macros from, 389
CPL examples, 351 Setting holiday schedules, 226 Navigation tree, capabilities,
Electronic reference, 25 Setting up call centers and 379
message forwarding, 221 Using the navigation tree, 382
BMTX-SVP01A-EN 643
Index
The tree menu and pop-up Grouping into security classes, Setup options for the operator
menus, 382 256 display, 541
See also System options Name in template field, 454 Enabling security at the
Setting connection features, Options, advanced, 526 operator display, 541
528 Properties, viewing, 27 Operator levels, See Security, 169
Network adapter, See Adapter References to an object, Optimal start/stop, 333, 338
Network number, need for unique locating, 601 Area mode settings, 285
in BACnet, 583 Referencing a property of, 22 How area control affects, 283
New Referencing indirectly in CPL Optimal start, definition, 629
Site, 34 text file, 358, 360 Optimization features for VAS
UCM, 139 Releasing control for output Comm5, 309
User, setting up, 170 objects, 253 Options, system, See System
NIC, See Adapter Security access for, 90, 268 options
Night economize Security, assigning access, 175 Output object
Area mode settings, 285 Showing object ID, 526 Analog output, 244
Definition, 628 Object types, operator display, Binary output, 247
How area control affects, 283 adding and deleting, 536–537 Definition, 233
Setting up, 294, 338 See also Operator display Naming, 252
Tracer 100 schedules, and, 340 Occupied mode, in VAS See also Input/output object
Night heat/cool Comm3/Comm4, 322 Output of reports, controlling, 512
Area mode settings, 285 Occupy, area mode settings, 285 Output, See Output object
Definition, 628 Off Alarm Limits field Over-pressurization of ducts, VAVs,
How area control affects, 283 requirements, 237 306
No access level of security, Offline Editing Override
definition, 169 Non-Trane device, 577 Analog output, 253
No Such Property message, 454 Offline programming Binary output, 253
Nobody Logged On Database requirement, 14 Setting for a UCM, 143
Need for user name, 177 Global changes, and, 18 VAVs in VAS Comm3/Comm4,
Setting up user profile, 176 Information flow in Tracer 324
Node Summit, 11 VAVs in VAS Comm5, 312
Definition, 379 Of existing site, 14 Overwriting settings, prevention of
Types of, 381 Of new site, 12 when offline, 14
See also Individual node types Offline, definition, 628
Non-Trane device Task manager, and, 201
Communication flow between Tracer 100 sites, 17 P
devices, 580 UCM type required, 13
Connection types, 573 Ways to use, 12 Page count, inserting into report,
Interfacing to, 574 Offset, setting for schedule 506
Network, need for unique members, 344 Page number, inserting into report,
number, 583 On Alarm Limits field requirements, 506
Offline Editing, 577 237 Page printing, 148
Providing information to other Online programming, 12 Pager
systems, 580 Information flow in Tracer Advanced options, 517
Role in BACnet setup, 581 Summit, 11 Editor, accessing, 165
Using BACnet for, 573 Online, definition, 629 Message forwarding, call
See also BACnet device(s) Terminal emulation, and, 393 centers, and, 215, 217, 218
Normal chiller, 278 Tracer 100 sites, 17 Object, creating, 166
Normal day, 333 Operator display, 529 Protocol, selecting, 167
Not used mode, 22 Accessing the editor, 530 Security access to, 167
Numeric Only paging protocol, 167 Adding event log, 60 Setting up, 165, 167
Creating a new BCU operator Paintshop Pro, 446, 568
display, 531 Palette, See Graphics editor palette
O Enabling custom screens, 543 Panel node, 381
Home screen, 539 Password
Object Selecting custom screens, 545 Assigning, 173
And property reference, 360, Setting up security, 180 Before security established, 169
526 Setting up the BCU operator Showing and hiding, 173
Assigning in CPL text file, 358 display, 534 Pause in dialing, code for, 162
Definition, 628 Selecting a device, 534 PC modem, See Modem, 33
Deleting, 599, 600, 605 Selecting members, 537 PC workstation
Creating in a site, 66
644 BMTX-SVP01A-EN
Index
Default device ID, 67, 524 Votes in VAS, 326 Selecting references for graphic
Definition, 629 Primary field, 434 fields, 421
Deleting from a site, 68 Printer Viewing an object’s properties,
Deleting last from site, 68 Adding in Windows, 148 27
Destination for restore function, Events, 148 Pulse meter input, 260
594, 595 Line-feed, 148
Device ID, assigning, 67, 524 Operating system, 8
Device ID, changing, 524 Page, 148 Q
Editing in a site, 67 Recommended for event log,
Enabling and disabling alarm, 148, 519 Quick trend report, See Trend
519 Selecting, 148 report, Standard
Master workstation, 12 Selecting for event log, 517
Modem, See PC workstation Setting up for reports, 512
modem Setup sequence, 8 R
Need for additional, 13 Tracer Summit, 8
Offline, 11 Tractor-feed, 148 RAM
Online, 11 Printing Definition, 630
Required for site creation, 57, 66 Alarms and events, 148 Random access memory, See RAM
Requirements for remote Electronic file, creating for Redialing, 159
communication, 7 BACnet, 589 Reference information in library, 25
Role in archiving trends, 477 Priority class, modifying name of, Referencer edit control fields, see
Setting up, 7 579 Referencers
Synchronization among Priority control, definition, 629 Referencers
multiple, 90 Priority shutdown Definition, 19, 630
Time and zone, setting up, 86 Area mode settings, 285 Failure of, 22
PC workstation modem Defining an enumeration for, Locating for an object to be
Adding in Windows, 150 362 deleted, 601
Configuring for BCU sites, 153 Profile Mode button, 19
Configuring for Tracer 100 or Assigning pre-defined to a user, Not used mode, 22
Tracker sites, 154 172 Referencer button, 21
Creating new, 151 Copying for a user, 172 Referencer mode, 21
Editor, accessing, 149 Nobody Logged On, modifying, Remote unit
Name, assigning, 152 177 Tracer 100 sites, 126
Object, creating, 152 Of user, 170 Report
Phone book, managing, 161 Setting up, 170 Auto generating file name, 512
Security access to, 164 Programmable control module, Backing up, 591
Setting up, 155 definition, 629 Blank row, adding, 506
PCX files, 13 Programming Body text, formatting, 508
Peak chiller, 278 Definition, 11 Calculation, using in report, 496
Peak for X Minute Interval In CPL, See CPL Column headings, entering, 507
calculation, 484 Offline, See Offline Date, inserting, 506
Phone book programming Deleting, 513
Adding for Tracer 100 or Tracker Online, See Online Designing, 502
panels, 125 programming Editing, 499, 502
Adding phone numbers, 162 Order checklist, 7 File format, 499
Editing phone numbers, 161 Setup sequence, 7 File name, 512
Removing phone numbers, 163 Property Footer, entering, 508
Setting up, 161 And object reference, 360 Formatting, 506
PIN for pager, 167 Definition, 629 Layout codes, 506
Point-to-point connection, See EIA- Editing graphic properties, 414 Member order, changing, 506
232 connection Printing out an object’s Members, defining, 503
Pre-defined profile, 172 properties, 28 Naming, 502
Pre-selected access for, 170 Reference for analog input, 237 Orientation, 502
Pre-defined user, deleting after Reference for analog output, Output options, 512
setup, 169 245 Page count, inserting into
Prefix for phone numbers, 162 Reference for binary input, 241, report, 506
Present value 242 Page number, inserting into
Changing for output objects, Reference for binary output, 248 report, 506
255 Referencing when offline, 22 Printer, setting up for reports,
Overriding for a UCM, 143 Releasing control in an area, 298 512
Role in changeover voting, 324 Selecting for reference, 22 Purpose of reporting, 495
BMTX-SVP01A-EN 645
Index
646 BMTX-SVP01A-EN
Index
Billing periods, defining, 80 Site connection process, Tracer Status text field, setup information
Configuration editor, See Site 100 or Tracker sites, 121 for, 423
configuration editor Site creation wizard Custom screen editor, 558
Configuring, 56 Restoring a site from, 53 Status, definition, 631
Tracer 100 or Tracker, 125 Site creation process, 34 Striped border on graphic field, 434
Configuring by Modem or Site creation process, Tracer 100 Supervisor of security, setting up,
Hardwired, 40 or Tracker sites, 120 169
Configuring via offline Site graphic Swing chiller, 278
programming, 13 Backing up, 591 Switch for billing period, 80
Connecting from navigation Definition, 631 Switching to run-time view, Custom
tree, 383 Effect of selecting save option, screen editor, 565
Control priorities, 7 442 Synchronization
Copying a site Restoring from a backup, 595 Automatic, 90
BCU site, 54 Site modem editor, See Modem Of device time in site, 89
Tracer 100 or Tracker, 122 editor Syntax of CPL, See CPL
Creating, 34 Site Name status field, 30 System node, 381
Tracer 100 or Tracker, 120 Snap to grid feature, 413 System options
Default site, 55 Custom screen editor, 565 Advanced, 526
Definition, 33, 631 Snapshot Advanced settings, 524
Deleting when currently logged Effect on sampling, 475 Alarm settings, 517
on, 606 Enabling and disabling, 475 Changing event log settings,
Deleting when not logged on, Referencing a trigger, 475 517
606 Resetting, 476 Changing home graphic, 516
Devices, listing, 61 Space comfort controller (SCC), 327, Changing workstation device ID,
Devices, synchronization of, 89 331 524
Devices, Tracer 100 or Tracker, Spacing on grid, configuring, 413 Editing, 515
126 Custom screen editor, 557 Selecting an e-mail profile for
Logging onto multiple, 173 Standard graphic message forwarding, 527
Multiple sites, managing, 33 Definition, 443, 445 Selecting event log printer, 517
Grouping sites, and, 183 Location, 445 Setting, 515
Task manager, and, 201 Replacing, 440 Setting connection features of
Name, inability to modify, 35 Restoring original, 443 the navigation tree, 528
Naming, 35 Saving, 439 Viewing system status, 29
PC workstation(s), managing, 66 Saving as custom graphic, 442 System, see Tracer Summit
Programming offline, 12, 14 Saving as site graphic, 441
Restoring a Tracer 100 or Saving edits to, 440
Tracker site, 598 Standard international units, 56 T
Restoring from a backup, 591, Standard live report
592 Definition, 499 Target field, 429
Security access, setting up, 90, Members, adding, 503 Context object for, 431
268 Membership rules, 503 Definition, 429, 632
Segmenting by security class, Selecting, 500 Destination, 429
256 Using to report on BACnet Displaying graphic in second
Selecting to configure, 55 objects, 587 window, 431
Setting up, 7 See also Report Inserting, 429
Single site setup, 33 Standard time, 88 Setup information for, 423
Time and date, setting, 86 Standard trend report Target External button, 422, 432
Tracer 100 or Tracker, 120 Definition, 499 Target image setup information,
UCM(s), managing, 74 Role in extracting Trends, 467 427
Site configuration editor Running automatically, 477 Using with template field, 454
Accessing, 55 Start debug option, 373 See also Custom screen editor
Accessing, Tracer 100 or Tracker Statement, adding to CPL text files, Task manager, 201
panels, 125 356 Accessing the Task manager
Capabilities, 33 Static text field, set up information schedule screen, 204
Tracer 100 or Tracker panels, for Archiving event log, 202
119 Custom screen editor, 561 Backing up a BCU site, 202
Site Connection Static text field, setup information Backup file location, 213
configuring a site by Modem or for, 423 Creating a task for groups of
Hardwired, 40 Status icon, locating on main sites, 210
Site connection wizard window, 29 Creating a task for single site,
Site connection process, 35, 45 206
BMTX-SVP01A-EN 647
Index
Four task types, 202 Offsets, setting for members, Tracer loop controller, 327, 329, 330,
Run immediate scan on single 344 331
site, 205 Removing a member from a Tracer Summit
Saving the event log as a text or schedule, 344 Backing up, 591
Excel file, 212 Removing event, 342 CD, 7
scanning sites, 202 Setting up day of the week, 339 Database, 11
Tracer 100 panel backup, 203 Tracer 100 schedules, 346 Definition, 633
Telephone numbers, See Phone Timed override Deleting items, 599
book Assign to event classes, 295 Optional packages, 1
Template field Binary trigger, BMTX, 259 Restoring, See Restore function
Context for, 418, 431, 458 Cancel timed override request, Window sizes available, 447
Context object, definition, 622 298 Tracer Summit BCU site node, 381
Definition, 454 Definition, 632 Tracker site node, 381
Effect on display of navigation How area control affects, 284 Tractor-feed printer, 148
tree, 443 Initiating TOV functionality for Trend
Eligible field types, 454 area members, 289 Archiving, 477
Filling in with permanent Setting up, 293 Communication requirements,
information, 458 Start timed override request, 477
Inserting, 455 298 Creating, 469
Object name in, 454 Title, entering for reports, 507 Definition, 467
Opening a graphic containing, to, 250 Interval of sampling, 474
457 Total Cooling Degree Days Member, See Member of a trend
Removing from a graphic, 458 calculation, 485 Naming, 472
Site name in, 454 Total Heating Degree Days Renaming, 472
Template graphic, definition, calculation, 486 Report, See Trend report
632 Total Run Hours/Starts calculation, Samples, See Sampling
Using with target field, 454 487 Saving, 477
Template, custom screen, 551 Tracer 100 or Tracker panels, 391 Security access to, 475
Terminal emulation, Tracer 100 or Altering panel memory, 393 Snapshot, See Snapshot
Tracker, 393 Background, 392 Trend editor, capabilities, 467
Test message Configuring a Tracer 100 panel, Trend log, definition, 634
e-mail forwarding, 224 125 Using in a report, 498
Text file Configuring a Tracker panel, 128 Trend object, See Trend
For CPL, See CPL text file Configuring ports, 392 Trend report, 477
Saving report as, 499 Creating keyboard macros, 395 Custom, selecting, 501
Text style, editing for graphic fields, Predefined macros, 400 Defining column heading for,
427 Creating Tracer 100 .SAV files, 503
Time 394 Definition, 496
Automatic synchronization of, Interfacing with the navigation Sample of, 498
90 tree, 393 Sampling in, 498
Changing, 88 Terminal emulation, 393 Standard, 499
Synchronization for devices, 89 See also Keyboard macros See also Report
See also Time and zone Tracer 100 or Tracker sites Troubleshooting
Time and date, setting for a site, 86 Configuring Tracer 100 or BACnet, 526
Time and zone, setting up, 86 Tracker panels, 125 Chiller marked as failed, 280
Time of day schedule reports, 348 Copying, 122 CPL routines affected when
Adding event information, 350 Creating, 120 input/output renamed, 252
Time of day scheduling, 333 Defining, 119 Failure of compile function, 369
Adding a member to a schedule, Editing a Tracer 100 keyboard Images not displaying properly
343 macro from the navigation in graphics editor, 416
Adding event, 340 tree, 389 Incomplete database, 30
Changing a schedule’s name, Restoring, 598 Interpreting CPL error codes,
342 Setting up a modem for, 154 376
Changing effective period, 345 Tracer 100 sites with multiple Limited BCU memory for trend
Creating a daily schedule, 335 panels, 129 samples, 472
Creating a time of day report, Adding panels, 131 Messages sent to wrong
333 See also COP panel workstation, 524
Creating a time of day schedule Using Tracer 100 schedules, 346 Referencer failure, 22
report, 348 See also Tracer 100 or Tracker Runtime errors halt CPL
Definition, 632 panels program, 373
During site setup, 8 Tracer 100 site node, 381
648 BMTX-SVP01A-EN
Index
System cannot locate graphic, Entering information for, 171 VAV auxiliary heat at night, 309
441 Modifying information for, 176 VAV calibration, 309
System cannot locate object, Nobody Logged On, 176 Ventilation optimization, 309
408 Operator levels, 170 VAV air system
Variables have wrong values, Setting up, 170 Variable air volume, definition,
373 User name 635
TXT file format, 499 Before security established, 169 VAV air system, see VAS
Deleting pre-defined user, 169 Comm3/Comm4, VAS Comm5
Nobody Logged On, need for, VAV I, 319, 321, 323
U 177 VAV II, 319, 321
VAV III, 319, 321
UCM VAV IV, 319, 321
Accessing information offline, V Ventilation optimization in VAS
13 Comm5, 309
Chiller, setting up, 280 Variable, 362, 365, 373 Ventilation, how area control
Configuring, 142 Using to reference an object, affects, 283
Creating in a site, 74 359 See also HVAC equipment
Creating new, 139 Using to reference an object Version of BCU, selecting to
Definition, 634 and property, 360 download, 79
Deleting from a site, 76 Viewing, 374 View only level of security,
Editor, accessing, 137 Variable air volume (VAV) boxes, definition, 169
Graphic display when offline, 13 315
Members, standard behavior, Variable air volume air system, see
284 VAS Comm3/Comm4, VAS W
Naming multiple UCMs in a site, Comm5
75 VAS Comm3/Comm4, 315–326 WAIT statement, 373
Overriding other values, 144 Accessing the VAS Waterflow valve
Overriding present value, 143 Comm3/Comm4 editor, 316 Balancing, 312
Releasing control of, 144 Air handler, selecting, 318 Weekly report, setting up, 509
Role of in a site, 74 Airflow drive max, 321 Window sizes in Tracer Summit,
Security access to, 145 Alarms, 325 447
Setting overrides for, 143 Assigning members, 318 Windows 98, 7
Setting up, 141 Capabilities, 315 Windows NT, 7
Viewing properties of, 27 Components, 315 Workstation alarm, enabling and
UCM node, 382 Creating object, 317 disabling, 519
UCP (unit control panel), definition, Drive VAVs to max flow, 325 Workstation, See PC workstation
634 Heat/cool decisions, 321
UCP1,See Chiller Minimum flow value, 320
UCP2,See Chiller Modifying, 320 Z
UDP port number, 38, 46, 48 MWU settings, See MWU
Unacknowledged Alarms status settings Zone
field, 30 Naming, 317 Definition, 636
Unit control module, See UCM, 33 Security access to, 325 Setting up, 86
Unit Controllers menu option, 137 Setpoints, modifying, 323 Zone control system, definition,
Units of measure Setting up, 320 636
Need for consistency in chillers, Voting for present value, 326 See also Time and zone
280 Voting setpoints, 324
Selecting for a new site, 56 VAS Comm5, 301–314
Unoccupied mode Accessing the VAS Comm5
Area mode settings, 285 editor, 302
In VAS Comm3/Comm4, 322 Assigning members, 304–307
UPCM (universal programmable Autocommissioning VAVs, 314
control module), definition, 634 Balancing air and water flow,
Uploading 312
Calculated analog and binary Common space VAVs, 306–307
objects, 196 Creating the object, 303–304
Uploading and downloading Duct pressure optimization, 309
BCU objects, 191 Global references, 310
Upper and lower case Security access to, 311
Security option, 174 Setting up, 308–309
User Supported controllers, 301
BMTX-SVP01A-EN 649
Index
650 BMTX-SVP01A-EN
Reader 1. In a word, how would you describe this guide?
________________________
Response 2. Using the following scale, rate the overall quality of this guide:
(Use the following scale.)
Form 1 2 3 4 5
Dreadful Terrific
5. When you actually try the instructions described in this guide, how
easily can you follow them?
1 2 3 4 5
I can’t Occasionally With
follow the the content great
instructions is confusing ease
at all.
6. How well did you understand the product before reading this guide?
1 2 3 4 5
Not at all Somewhat Thoroughly
7. How well did you understand the product after reading the guide?
1 2 3 4 5
Not at all Somewhat Thoroughly
Please send this form 8. The best aspect of this guide is __________________________________
by fax or mail to:
_______________________________________________________________
Trane GCC
Product Communications
4833 White Bear Parkway 9. If we were to change one aspect of this guide, it should be _________
St. Paul, MN 55110
_______________________________________________________________
(fax) 651-407-4198
10. Name, e-mail address: (optional) _________________________________
_______________________________________________________________
BMTX-SVP01A-EN 651
Reader Response Form
652 BMTX-SVP01A-EN
Literature Order Number BMTX-SVP01A-EN
File Number SV-ES-BAS-BMTX SVP-01A-EN-0704
Supersedes BAS-BMTW-SVP-01E-EN September 2003
Trane Stocking Location Inland
A business of American Standard Companies
www.trane.com
Trane has a policy of continuous product and product data improvement and reserves the right to
For more information, contact your local Trane change design and specifications without notice. Only qualified technicians should perform the installa-
office or e-mail us at [email protected] tion and servicing of equipment referred to in this publication.